Novel Compounds As Antagonists Or Inverse Agonists At Opioid Receptors

- GlaxoSmithKline LLC

Novel compounds which are antagonists or inverse agonists at one or more of the opioid receptors, pharmaceutical compositions containing them, to processes for their preparation.

Skip to: Description  ·  Claims  · Patent History  ·  Patent History
Description
CROSS-REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS

This application is filed as a continuation application of U.S. Ser. No. 12/376,580, filed Feb. 6, 2009, which is a National Phase Application of International Application No. PCT/EP2007/075422 filed Aug. 8, 2007, which claims priority from 60/821,845 filed Aug. 9, 2006 in the United States.

FIELD OF THE INVENTION

This invention relates to novel compounds which are antagonists or inverse agonists at one or more of the opioid receptors, to pharmaceutical compositions containing them, to processes for their preparation, and to their use in therapy.

BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION

Obesity is a medical condition that is reaching epidemic proportions among humans throughout the world. It is a condition that is associated with other diseases or conditions that disrupt life and lifestyles. Obesity is recognized as a serious risk factor for other diseases and/or conditions such as diabetes, hypertension, and arteriosclerosis. It is also known that increased body weight due to obesity can place a burden on joints, such as knee joints, causing arthritis, pain, and stiffness.

Because overeating and obesity have become such a problem, many individuals are interested in weight reduction and/or maintaining a healthy body weight.

The ability to bind antagonistically to opioid receptors has been suggested to be useful for treatment of many other diseases or conditions not related to obesity including drug and/or substance addiction, depression, opiate overdose, irritable bowel syndrome, schizophrenia, compulsive disorders, septic shock, nausea, vomiting, and stroke. This ability may be useful for the treatment of obesity as well. It has been suggested that the opioid receptors may play a role in control of food intake and food selection. (See, for example, Bodnar, R. J., in Peptides, 25, (2004), p. 697.) Antagonists or inverse agonists of the opioid receptors have been shown to reduce body weight in obese rats.

There is, therefore, an ongoing need for new opioid antagonists for the treatment of obesity, diseases and/or conditions associated with obesity, as well as the above-mentioned non-obesity related diseases and/or conditions.

SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION

The present invention provides a compound of Formula I or Formula Ia,

a salt, a solvate, or physiologically functional derivative thereof wherein:

ring A is selected from the group consisting of aryl, 5-membered heteroaryl, and 6-membered heteroaryl, with the proviso that in Formula I when (i) ring A is pyridyl, (ii) ring B is phenyl, and (iii) E is in the meta position relative to the bond joining ring A to ring B, the bond joining D to ring B is in the para position relative to the bond joining ring A to ring B and in Formula Ia, ring A is attached to the tetrahydroisoqinolyl ring at carbon 6 or carbon 7;

ring B is selected from the group consisting of aryl, 5-membered heteroaryl, and 6-membered heteroaryl;

D is —CH2—, —O—, or —CH(CH3)—, with the proviso that D is not attached to ring B at the atom adjacent to the bond joining rings A and B;

E is selected from the group consisting of —C(O)NH2, —C(O)NHC1-3alkyl, —C(O)NH(C1-3alkyl)aryl, —NHC(O)C1-3alkyl, 5-membered heterocycle, 6-membered heterocycle, 5-membered heteroaryl, and 6-membered heteroaryl, with the proviso that in Formula I E is not attached to the atom adjacent to the bond joining rings A and B;

R1 and R2 are selected independently from the group consisting of —F, —Cl, —Br, —OH, —CN, —C1-3alkyl, —OC1-3alkyl, —C1-3fluoroalkyl, —OC1-3fluoroalkyl; m and n are each independently 0, 1, or 2;

J is a bond or a C1-4alkylene;

R3 is selected from the group consisting of —H, C1-12alkyl, C3-10cycloalkyl, alkoxycarbonyl, arylalkyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkyl, heteroarylalkyl, cycloalkenyl, C2-12fluoroalkyl, and heteroalkyl;

R4 is selected from the group consisting of C3-12alkyl, C3-10cycloalkyl, arylalkyl, heterocyclyl, heterocyclylalkyl, heteroarylalkyl, cycloalkenyl, C3-12fluoroalkyl, and heteroalkyl; or

R3 and R4 may be joined to form a substituted or unsubstituted 5-7 membered ring.

The present invention also provides a pharmaceutical composition comprising a compound of Formula I or Formula Ia, a salt, solvate, or physiologically functional derivative thereof and one or more excipients.

And the present invention further provides a method of treatment comprising the administering to a mammal, particularly a human, a pharmaceutical composition comprising (i) a compound of Formula I or Formula Ia, a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, or physiologically functional derivative thereof and (ii) at least one excipient or carrier, wherein said treatment is for a disease or condition selected from the group consisting of obesity, diabetes, hypertension, depression, anxiety, drug addiction, substance addiction, or a combination thereof. Preferably the disease or condition is obesity.

There is further provided processes for making compounds of Formula I or Formula Ia, salts, solvates, and physiologically functional derivatives thereof.

DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF THE INVENTION

In Formulae I and Ia, ring A is selected from the group consisting of aryl, 5-membered heteroaryl, and 6-membered heteroaryl, with the proviso that in Formula I when (i) ring A is pyridyl, (ii) ring B is phenyl, and (iii) E is in the meta position relative to the bond joining ring A to ring B, the bond joining D to ring B is in the para position relative to the bond joining ring A to ring B. Preferably in Formulae I and Ia, ring A is selected from the group consisting of phenyl, thiophenyl, furanyl, oxazolyl, and pyridyl. Of these, preferably ring A is phenyl or pyridyl; most preferably ring A is phenyl. In Formula Ia ring A is attached to the tetrahydroisoquinolyl ring either through carbon 6 or carbon 7.

Ring B of Formula I is selected from the group consisting aryl, 5-membered heteroaryl, and 6-membered heteroaryl. Preferably in Formula I, ring B is selected from the group consisting of phenyl, thiophenyl, furanyl, and pyridyl. Of these, preferably ring B is phenyl or pyridyl; most preferably ring B is phenyl.

In one embodiment of Formula I, ring A and ring B are both selected from the group consisting of phenyl and pyridyl. In Formula I, it is further preferred that ring A and ring B both be phenyl. In a preferred embodiment of Formula I, ring A and ring B are both phenyl and ring B is substituted one or two times with a halogen such as fluoro or chloro.

In Formula I, D is —CH2—, —O—, or —CH(CH3)—, with the proviso that D is not attached to ring B at the atom adjacent to the bond that joins ring A to ring B. That is, D is not attached to ring B at the ortho position to the bond that joins ring A to ring B. Preferably in Formula I, D is —CH2— or —O—.

E of Formulae I and Ia is selected from the group consisting of —C(O)NH2, —C(O)NHC1-3alkyl, —C(O)NH(C1-3alkyl)aryl, —NHC(O)C1-3alkyl, 5-membered heterocycle, 6-membered heterocycle, 5-membered heteroaryl, and 6-membered heteroaryl, with the proviso that E is not attached to the carbon atom adjacent (i.e., “ortho” position) to the bond joining rings A and B. Preferably, in Formula I and Formula Ia, E is selected from the group consisting of —C(O)NH2, imidazolidinyl, imidazolidinedionyl, imidazoyl, imidazolinonyl, triazolyl, triazolinonyl, pyridyl and their tautomers. Most preferably in Formula I and Formula Ia, E is C(O)NH2 or triazolyl.

In Formulae I and Ia, R1 and R2 are selected independently from the group consisting of —H, —F, —Cl, —Br, —OH, —CN, —C1-3alkyl, —OC1-3alkyl, —C1-3fluoroalkyl, —OC1-3fluoroalkyl. Preferably, R1 and R2 are selected independently from the group consisting of —F, —Cl, —CH3, —CF3, and —OCH3. In [R1]n and [R2]m, m and n are each independently 0, 1, or 2.

J in Formula I is a bond or a C1-4alkylene. Preferably, in Formula I, D is —CH2— and J is a bond or C1-2alkylene. In one embodiment of Formula I, when D is —CH2— then J is a bond or C1-2alkylene. Also, preferably, in Formula I, when D is —O— then J is C2-3alkylene.

In Formula I, R3 is selected from the group consisting of —H, C1-12alkyl, C3-10cycloalkyl, alkoxycarbonyl, arylalkyl, heterocyclyl, heterocycloalkyl, heteroarylalkyl, cycloalkenyl, C2-12fluoroalkyl, and heteroalkyl. R3 can be substituted or unsubstituted.

R4 of Formulae I and Ia is selected from the group consisting of C3-12alkyl, C3-10cycloalkyl, arylalkyl, heterocyclyl, heterocycloalkyl, heteroarylalkyl, cycloalkenyl, C3-12fluoroalkyl, and heteroalkyl. R4 can be substituted or unsubstituted. Preferably, in Formula I, R3 is —H. Preferably, in both Formula I and Formula Ia, R4 is selected from the group consisting of arylmethyl, arylethyl, heteroarylmethyl, heteroarylethyl, C4-10alkyl, cycloalkenyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclylmethyl, and heterocyclylethyl; such as, but not limited to 3-fluorophenylethyl, 3-fluorobenzyl, 2-trifluoromethylbenzyl, 2-trifluoromethoxybenzyl, 4-trifluoromethylbenzyl, 4-fluorobenzyl, 3-methoxyphenylethyl, 3-thiophenylmethyl, 2-thiophenylethyl, 4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl, 3,3-dimethylcyclohexyl, 2-indanyl, 5-cyano-2-indanyl, 5-methoxy-2-indanyl, 5-fluoro-2-indanyl, 4-fluoro-2-indanyl, 4-methoxy-2-indanyl, 4-methoxy-2-indanyl, 4,8-difluoro-2-indanyl, 5,6-difluoro-2-indanyl, 5,6-dimethoxy-2-indanyl, 2-methyl-2-indanyl, cyclohexylmethyl, cyclohexylethyl, 4,4-difluorocyclohexyl, 1-cyclohexenylmethyl, 1-cyclohexenylethyl, cyclooctyl, cycloheptylmethyl, 3-methylbutyl, adamantyl, morpholinoethyl, piperidinylethyl, 4-tert-butylcyclohexyl, 3,3,5,5-tetramethylcyclohexyl, 3,5-difluorobenzyl, 3,5-difluorophenylethyl, 2-diphenylmethyl, methoxyethyl, dimethylaminoethyl, 3-pyridinylethyl, 3-pyridinylmethyl, and phenyloxyethyl. Of these, preferably R4 is selected from among the group consisting of 2-indanyl, 5-fluoro-2-indanyl, 4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl, cyclohexylethyl, cyclohexylmethyl, 2-thiophenylethyl, 3-fluorophenylethyl, 3-methylbutyl, and 4,4-difluorocyclohexyl.

Or, in Formula I, R3 and R4 may be joined to form a substituted or unsubstituted 5-7 membered ring, including rings such as, but not limited to piperidinyl, piperizinyl, morpholinyl, azepinyl, tetrahydroisoquinolinyl, dihydroindolyl, and pyrrolidinyl.

Particularly preferred compounds of Formula I are selected from the group consisting of 4′-{[(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)amino]methyl}-3-biphenylcarboxamide; 4′-[(2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-ylamino)methyl]-3-biphenylcarboxamide; N-{[3′-(1H-imidazol-2-yl)-4-biphenylyl]methyl}-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine; 4′-{[(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)amino]methyl}-2-fluoro-3-biphenylcarboxamide; 4′-{[(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)amino]methyl}-2-methyl-3-biphenylcarboxamide; 4′-{[(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)amino]methyl}-2′-(trifluoromethyl)-3-biphenylcarboxamide; 3′-fluoro-4′-({[(2S)-5-fluoro-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl]amino}methyl)-3-biphenylcarboxamide; 1-{4′-[(2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-ylamino)methyl]-3-biphenylyl}-2,4-imidazolidinedione; N-{[3′-(1H-imidazol-2-yl)-4-biphenylyl]methyl}-4,4-dimethylcyclohexanamine; N-{[3,5-difluoro-3′-(1H-imidazol-2-yl)-4-biphenylyl]methyl}-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine; N-{[3,5-difluoro-3′-(1H-1,2,4-triazol-3-yl)-4-biphenylyl]methyl}-4,4-dimethylcyclohexanamine; N-{[3,5-difluoro-3′-(1H-1,2,4-triazol-3-yl)-4-biphenylyl]methyl}-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine; and 2′-chloro-4′-{[(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)amino]methyl}-3-biphenylcarboxamide, including their salts, solvates, and physiologically functional derivatives. The preferred salts of these named compounds are a citrate, phosphate, or hydrochloride salt (mono- and di-). Tautomers of these compounds and their salts are also preferred.

The most preferred compound is N-{[3,5-difluoro-3′-(1H-1,2,4-triazol-3-yl)-4-biphenylyl]methyl}-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine or a salt thereof. A citrate, phosphate or mono- or di-hydrochloride salt of N-{[3,5-difluoro-3′-(1H-1,2,4-triazol-3-yl)-4-biphenylyl]methyl}-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine is especially preferred.

In Formula Ia ring A is attached to the tetrahydroisoquinolyl ring either through carbon 6 or carbon 7, and E, R1, R2, and R4 are as described for Formula I. The preferred point of attachment of ring A to the tetrahydroisoquinolyl ring is through carbon 6 in Formula Ia.

There is provided a pharmaceutical composition comprising (i) a compound of Formula I or Formula Ia, a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, or physiologically functional derivative thereof and (ii) at least one carrier (also referred to as an excipient or diluent), preferably a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier.

Further, there is provided a method of treatment (including prophylaxis) comprising the administering to a mammal, especially a human, a pharmaceutical composition comprising (i) a compound of Formula I or Formula Ia, a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, or physiologically functional derivative thereof and (ii) at least one carrier (excipient or diluent). There also is provided a method of treatment (including prophylaxis) comprising the administering to a mammal, especially a human, a compound of Formula I or Formula Ia, a pharmaceutically acceptable salt, solvate, or physiologically functional derivative thereof.

One aspect of the present invention includes a compound (salt, solvate, or functional derivative thereof) of the present invention for use as an active therapeutic substance.

Another aspect of the present invention includes a compound of Formula I or Formula Ia, a salt, a solvate, or a functional derivative thereof for use in the treatment (including prophylaxis) of obesity, diabetes, hypertension, depression (major and/or bipolar), anxiety, drug addiction, and/or substance addiction. Of these conditions/diseases, obesity is preferred.

Still another aspect of the present invention includes the use of a compound of Formula I or Formula Ia, a salt, a solvate, or a functional derivative thereof in the manufacture of a medicament for use in the treatment (including prophylaxis) of obesity, diabetes, hypertension, depression (major and/or bipolar), anxiety, drug addiction, and/or substance addiction. Of these conditions/diseases, obesity is preferred.

Processes for making the compounds of Formula I or Formula Ia, salts, solvates, and physiologically functional derivatives thereof are also set forth.

Terms are used within their accepted meanings. The following definitions are meant to clarify, but not limit, the terms defined.

As used herein, the term “alkyl” refers to a straight or branched chain alkyl, preferably having from one to twelve carbon atoms, which may be unsubstituted or substituted, with multiple degrees of substitution included within the present invention. Examples of “alkyl” as used herein include, but are not limited to, methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, isobutyl, n-butyl, t-butyl, isopentyl, n-pentyl, and the like, as well as substituted versions thereof.

As used herein, the term “alkylene” refers to a straight or branched chain divalent alkyl radical, preferably having from one to ten carbon atoms. Alkylene groups as defined herein may be unsubstituted or substituted, with multiple degrees of substitution included within the present invention. Examples of “alkylene” as used herein include, but are not limited to, methylenyl, ethylenyl, n-propylenyl, n-butylenyl, and the like, as well as substituted versions thereof.

As used herein, the term “cycloalkyl” refers to an unsubstituted or substituted mono- or polycyclic non-aromatic saturated ring, which optionally includes an alkylene linker through which the cycloalkyl may be attached. Exemplary “cycloalkyl” groups include, but are not limited to, cyclopropyl, cyclobutyl, cyclopentyl, cyclohexyl, cycloheptyl, and the like, as well as unsubstituted and substituted versions thereof. As used herein, the term “cycloalkyl” includes unsubstituted and substituted fused polycyclic hydrocarbon saturated ring and aromatic ring system, namely polycyclic hydrocarbons with less than maximum number of non-cumulative double bonds, for example where a saturated hydrocarbon ring (such as a cyclopentyl ring) is fused with an aromatic ring (herein “aryl,” such as a benzene ring) to form, for example, groups such as indane.

As used herein, the term “cycloalkenyl” refers to unsubstituted and substituted non-aromatic ring containing one or more carbon-to-carbon double bonds which optionally includes an alkylene linker through which the cycloalkenyl may be attached, with multiple degrees of substitution included within the present invention. Exemplary “cycloalkenyl” groups include, but are not limited to, cyclopropenyl, cyclobutenyl, cyclopentenyl, cyclohexenyl, cycloheptenyl, and the like, as well as substituted versions thereof.

As used herein, the term “heterocycle” or “heterocyclyl” refers to unsubstituted and substituted mono- or polycyclic non-aromatic ring system containing one or more heteroatoms. Preferred heteroatoms include N, O, and/or S, including N-oxides, sulfur oxides, and dioxides. Preferably the ring is three to twelve-membered and is either fully saturated or has one or more degrees of unsaturation. Multiple degrees of substitution are included within the present definition. Such rings may be optionally fused to one or more of another “heterocyclic” ring(s) or cycloalkyl ring(s). Examples of “heterocyclic” groups include, but are not limited to, tetrahydrofuranyl, pyranyl, 1,4-dioxanyl, 1,3-dioxanyl, piperidinyl, pyrrolidinyl, morpholinyl, imidazolidinedionyl, imidazolidinonyl, and their various tautomers.

As used herein, the term “heterocyclylalkyl” refers to a heterocycle, as defined herein, bonded to an alkyl group, as defined herein.

As used herein, the term “arylalkyl” refers to an aryl group, as defined herein, bonded to an alkyl group, as defined herein.

As used herein, the term “heteroalkyl” refers to an alkyl group, as defined herein, wherein one or more of the carbon atoms of the alkyl group are replaced by a heteroatom. Preferred heteroatoms include N, O, and/or S, including N-oxides, sulfur oxides, and sulfur dioxides.

As used herein, the term “aryl” refers to unsubstituted and substituted benzene ring. Multiple degrees of substitution are included within the present definition. Examples of “aryl” groups include, but are not limited to, phenyl, benzyl, biphenyl and the like, as well as substituted derivatives thereof.

As used herein, the term “heteroaryl” refers to unsubstituted and substituted monocyclic five to seven membered aromatic ring. These heteroaryl rings contain one or more heteroatoms such as nitrogen, sulfur, and/or oxygen atoms, where N-oxides, sulfur oxides, and dioxides are permissible heteroatom substitutions. Multiple degrees of substitution are included within the present definition. Examples of “heteroaryl” groups used herein include, but should not be limited to, furanyl, thiophenyl, pyrrolyl, imidazolyl, pyrazolyl, triazolyl, tetrazolyl, thiazolyl, oxazolyl, isoxazolyl, oxadiazolyl, thiadiazolyl, isothiazolyl, pyridinyl, pyridazinyl, pyrazinyl, pyrimidinyl, and the like, as well as substituted versions thereof.

As used herein, the term “heteroarylalkyl” refers to a heteroaryl as defined herein bonded to an alkyl as defined herein.

As used herein, the term “halogen” refers to fluorine (or fluoro), chlorine (or chloro), bromine (or bromo), or iodine (or iodo). Preferably, each halogen when present is individually either fluorine or chlorine.

As used herein, the term “fluoroalkyl” refers to an alkyl group, as defined herein, that is substituted with at least one fluorine atom. Examples of branched or straight chained “fluoroalkyl” groups useful in the present invention include, but are not limited to, methyl, ethyl, propyl, isopropyl, n-butyl, and t-butyl substituted independently with one or more fluorine. The term “fluoroalkyl” should be interpreted to include such substituents as perfluoroalkyl groups and the like.

As used herein, the term “alkoxy” refers to the group —ORa, where Ra is alkyl as defined above.

As used herein, the term “alkoxycarbonyl” refers to the group —C(O)ORa, where Ra is alkyl as herein defined

As used herein, the term “nitro” refers to the group —NO2.

As used herein, the term “cyano” refers to the group —CN.

As used herein, the term “azido” refers to the group —N3.

As used herein, the term “acyl” refers to the group —C(O)Rb, where Rb is alkyl, aryl, heteroaryl, or heterocyclyl, as each is defined herein.

As used herein, the term “oxo” refers to the group ═O.

The terms “members” (and variants thereof, e.g., “membered”) in the context of heterocyclic, heteroaryl, heteroaromatic, aryl, and aromatic groups refers to the total atoms, carbons and heteroatoms (e.g., N, O, and S) which form the ring. Thus, an example of a 6-membered heterocyclic ring is piperidine; an example of a 6-membered heteroaryl is pyridine; and an example of a 6-membered aryl ring is benzene.

As used herein, the term “optionally” means that the subsequently described event(s) may or may not occur, and includes both event(s) that occur and event(s) that do not occur.

Also, as used herein throughout the present specification, the phrase “optionally substituted” or variations thereof denote an optional substitution, including multiple degrees of substitution, with one or more substitutent group. The phrase should not be interpreted as duplicative of the substitutions herein described and depicted. Exemplary optional substituent groups include acyl; alkyl; alkylsulfonyl; alkoxy; alkoxycarbonyl; cyano; halogen; haloalkyl; hydroxy; oxo; nitro; aryl, which may be further substituted with acyl, alkoxy, alkyl, alkylsulfonyl, cyano, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, or nitro; heteroaryl, which may be further substituted with acyl, alkoxy, alkyl, alkylsulfonyl, cyano, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, or nitro; or —N(R*)2; where for each occurrence R* is independently selected from hydrogen, alkyl, cycloalkyl, heterocyclyl, aryl, aralkyl, heteroaryl, heteroaralkyl, alkylsulfonyl, arylsulfonyl, or heteroarylsulfonyl, where each occurrence of such aryl or heteroaryl may be substituted with one or more acyl, alkoxy, alkyl, alkenyl, alkylsulfonyl, cyano, halogen, haloalkyl, hydroxy, or nitro, or the two R*s may combine to form a ring, optionally having additional heteroatoms (e.g., N, O, S, etc.), optionally having one or more degrees of unsaturation, and optionally being further substituted with acyl, alkoxy, alkyl, halogen, or haloalkyl.

The compounds of Formula I and Formula Ia may crystallize in more than one form, a characteristic known as polymorphism, and such polymorphic forms (“polymorphs”) are within the scope of Formula I and Formula Ia. Polymorphism generally can occur as a response to changes in temperature, pressure, or both. Polymorphism can also result from variations in the crystallization process. Polymorphs can be distinguished by various physical characteristics known in the art such as x-ray diffraction patterns, solubility, and melting point.

Certain compounds of Formula I and Formula Ia may exist in stereoisomeric forms (e.g., they may contain one or more asymmetric carbon atoms or may exhibit cis-trans isomerism). The individual stereoisomers (enantiomers and diastereomers) and mixtures of these are included within the scope of the present invention. The present invention also covers the individual isomers of the compounds represented by Formula I and Formula Ia as mixtures with isomers thereof in which one or more chiral centers are inverted. Certain compounds of Formula I and Formula Ia may be prepared as regioisomers. The present invention covers both the mixture of regioisomers as well as individual compounds. Likewise, it is understood that compounds of Formula I and Formula Ia may exist in tautomeric forms other than that shown in the formula and these are also included within the scope of the present invention. It is to be understood that the present invention includes all combinations and subsets of the particular groups defined herein above. The scope of the present invention includes mixtures of stereoisomers as well as purified enantiomers or enantiomerically/diastereomerically enriched mixtures. Also included within the scope of the invention are the individual isomers of the compounds represented by Formula I and Formula Ia, as well as any wholly or partially equilibrated mixtures thereof. The present invention also includes the individual isomers of the compounds represented by the formula as well as mixtures with isomers thereof in which one or more chiral centers are inverted.

Typically the salts of compounds of Formula I and Formula Ia of the present invention are pharmaceutically acceptable salts. Salts encompassed within the term “pharmaceutically acceptable salts” refer to non-toxic salts of the compounds of this invention. Salts of the compounds of the present invention may comprise acid addition salts. In general, the salts are formed from pharmaceutically acceptable inorganic and organic acids. More specific examples of suitable acid salts include maleic, hydrochloric, hydrobromic, sulphuric, phosphoric, nitric, perchloric, fumic, acetic, propionic, succinic, glycolic, formic, lactic, aleic, tartaric, citric, palmoic, malonic, hydroxymaleic, phenylacetic, glutamic, benzoic, salicylic, fumaric, toluenesulfonic, methansulfonic (mesylate), naphthaliene-2-sulfonic, benzenesulfonic, hydroxynaphthoic, hydroiodic, malic, teroic, tannic, and the like.

Other representative salts include acetate, benzenesulfonate, benzoate, bicarbonate, bisulfate, bitartrate, borate, calcium edetate, camsylate, carbonate, clavulanate, citrate, dihydrochloride, edisylate, estolate, esylate, fumarate, gluceptate, gluconate, glutamate, glycollylarsanilate, hexylresorcinate, hydrobromide, hydrochloride, hydroxynaphthoate, iodide, isethionate, lactate, lactobionate, laurate, malate, maleate, mandelate, mesylate, methylsulfate, monopotassium maleate, mucate, napsylate, nitrate, oxalate, pamoate (embonate), palmitate, pantothenate, phosphate/diphosphate, polygalacturonate, salicylate, stearate, subacetate, succinate, sulfate, tannate, tartrate, teoclate, tosylate, and valerate salts.

Other salts, which are not pharmaceutically acceptable, may be useful in the preparation of compounds of this invention and these should be considered to form a further aspect of the invention. These salts, such as oxalic and trifluoroacetic, while not in themselves pharmaceutically acceptable, may be useful in the preparation of salts useful as intermediates in obtaining the compounds of the invention and their pharmaceutically acceptable salts.

As used herein, the term “solvate” refers to a complex of variable stoichiometry formed by a solute (in this invention, a compound of Formula I and Formula Ia, or a salt or physiologically functional derivative thereof) and a solvent. Such solvents, for the purpose of the invention, should not interfere with the biological activity of the solute. Non-limiting examples of suitable solvents include, but are not limited to water, methanol, ethanol, and acetic acid. Preferably the solvent used is a pharmaceutically acceptable solvent. Most preferably the solvent used is water and the solvate is a hydrate.

As used herein, the term “physiologically functional derivative” refers to any pharmaceutically acceptable derivative of a compound of the present invention that, upon administration to a mammal, is capable of providing (directly or indirectly) a compound of the present invention or an active metabolite thereof. Such derivatives, for example, esters and amides, will be clear to those skilled in the art, without undue experimentation. Reference may be made to the teaching of Burger's Medicinal Chemistry And Drug Discovery, 5th Edition, Vol 1: Principles and Practice, which is incorporated herein by reference to the extent that it teaches physiologically functional derivatives.

Processes for preparing pharmaceutically acceptable salts, solvates, and physiologically functional derivatives of the compounds of Formula I and Formula Ia are generally known in the art. See, for example, Burger's Medicinal Chemistry and Drug Discovery, 5th Edition, Volume 1: Principles and Practice.

As used herein, the term “effective amount” means that amount of a drug or pharmaceutical agent that will elicit the biological or medical response of a tissue, system, animal, or human that is being sought, for instance, by a researcher or clinician. The term “therapeutically effective amount” means any amount which, as compared to a corresponding subject who has not received such amount, results in improved treatment, healing, prevention, or amelioration of a disease, disorder, or side effect, or a decrease in the rate of advancement of a disease or disorder. The term also includes within its scope amounts effective to enhance normal physiological function. For use in therapy, therapeutically effective amounts of a compound of Formula I and Formula Ia, as well as salts, solvates, and physiologically functional derivatives thereof, may be administered as the raw chemical. Additionally, the active ingredient may be presented as a pharmaceutical composition.

As used herein, the term “treatment” includes prophylaxis and refers to alleviating the specified condition, eliminating or reducing one or more symptoms of the condition, slowing or eliminating the progression of the condition, and preventing or delaying the reoccurrence of the condition in a previously afflicted or diagnosed patient or subject. Prophylaxis (or prevention or delay of disease onset) is typically accomplished by administering a drug in the same or similar manner as one would to a patient with the developed disease or condition.

Accordingly, the invention further provides pharmaceutical compositions (also referred to herein as “pharmaceutical formulations’) that include effective amounts of compounds of the Formula I or Formula Ia, salts, solvates, or physiologically functional derivatives thereof, and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable excipients (including carriers and/or diluents). The compounds of Formula I and Formula Ia, salts, solvates, and physiologically functional derivatives thereof, are as herein described. The carrier(s), diluent(s) or excipient(s) must be acceptable, in the sense of being compatible with the other ingredients of the formulation and not deleterious to the recipient of the pharmaceutical composition.

In accordance with another aspect of the invention there is also provided a process for the preparation of a pharmaceutical formulation including admixing a compound of the Formula I or Formula Ia, a salt, solvate, or physiologically functional derivative thereof, with one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, diluents or excipients.

A therapeutically effective amount of a compound of the present invention will depend upon a number of factors. For example, the species, age, and weight of the recipient, the precise condition requiring treatment and its severity, the nature of the formulation, and the route of administration are all factors to be considered. The therapeutically effective amount ultimately should be at the discretion of the attendant physician or veterinarian. Regardless, an effective amount of a compound of Formula I or Formula Ia (salt, solvate, or derivative thereof) for the treatment of humans suffering from frailty, generally, should be in the range of 0.1 to 100 mg/kg body weight of recipient (mammal) per day. More usually the effective amount should be in the range of 1 to 10 mg/kg body weight per day. Thus, for a 70 kg adult mammal the actual amount per day would usually be from 70 to 700 mg. This amount may be given in a single dose per day or in a number (such as two, three, four, five, or more) of sub-doses per day such that the total daily dose is the same. An effective amount of a salt, solvate, or physiologically functional derivative thereof, may be determined as a proportion of the effective amount of the compound of Formula I or Formula Ia (salt, solvate, or derivative thereof) per se. Similar dosages should be appropriate for treatment (including prophylaxis) of the other conditions referred to herein.

Pharmaceutical formulations may be presented in unit dose forms containing a predetermined amount of active ingredient per unit dose. Such a unit may contain, as a non-limiting example, 0.5 mg to 1 g of a compound of the Formula I or Formula Ia (alternatively, asalt, solvate, or derivative thereof), depending on the condition being treated, the route of administration, and the age, weight, and condition of the patient. Preferred unit dosage formulations are those containing a daily dose or sub-dose, as herein above recited, or an appropriate fraction thereof, of an active ingredient. Such pharmaceutical formulations may be prepared by any of the methods well known in the pharmacy art.

Pharmaceutical formulations may be adapted for administration by any appropriate route, for example by an oral (including buccal or sublingual), rectal, nasal, topical (including buccal, sublingual or transdermal), vaginal, or parenteral (including subcutaneous, intramuscular, intravenous or intradermal) route. Such formulations may be prepared by any method known in the art of pharmacy, for example by bringing into association the active ingredient with the carrier(s) or excipient(s). In the present invention oral routes are preferred.

Pharmaceutical formulations adapted for oral administration may be presented as discrete units such as capsules or tablets; powders or granules; solutions or suspensions, each with aqueous or non-aqueous liquids; edible foams or whips; or oil-in-water liquid emulsions or water-in-oil liquid emulsions. For instance, for oral administration in the form of a tablet or capsule, the active drug component can be combined with an oral, non-toxic pharmaceutically acceptable inert carrier such as ethanol, glycerol, water, and the like. Generally, powders are prepared by comminuting the compound to a suitable fine size and mixing with an appropriate pharmaceutical carrier such as an edible carbohydrate, as, for example, starch or mannitol. Flavorings, preservatives, dispersing agents, and coloring agents can also be present.

Capsules are made by preparing a powder, liquid, or suspension mixture and encapsulating with gelatin or some other appropriate shell material. Glidants and lubricants such as colloidal silica, talc, magnesium stearate, calcium stearate, or solid polyethylene glycol can be added to the mixture before the encapsulation. A disintegrating or solubilizing agent such as agar-agar, calcium carbonate or sodium carbonate can also be added to improve the availability of the medicament when the capsule is ingested. Moreover, when desired or necessary, suitable binders, lubricants, disintegrating agents, and coloring agents can also be incorporated into the mixture. Examples of suitable binders include starch, gelatin, natural sugars such as glucose or beta-lactose, corn sweeteners, natural and synthetic gums such as acacia, tragacanth, or sodium alginate, carboxymethylcellulose, polyethylene glycol, waxes, and the like. Lubricants useful in these dosage forms include, for example, sodium oleate, sodium stearate, magnesium stearate, sodium benzoate, sodium acetate, sodium chloride, and the like. Disintegrators include, without limitation, starch, methyl cellulose, agar, bentonite, xanthan gum, and the like.

Tablets are formulated, for example, by preparing a powder mixture, granulating or slugging, adding a lubricant and disintegrant, and pressing into tablets. A powder mixture may be prepared by mixing the compound, suitably comminuted, with a diluent or base as described above. Optional ingredients include binders such as carboxymethylcellulose, aliginates, gelatins, or polyvinyl pyrrolidone, solution retardants such as paraffin, resorption accelerators such as a quaternary salt, and/or absorption agents such as bentonite, kaolin, or dicalcium phosphate. The powder mixture can be wet-granulated with a binder such as syrup, starch paste, acadia mucilage or solutions of cellulosic or polymeric materials, and forcing through a screen. As an alternative to granulating, the powder mixture can be run through the tablet machine and the result is imperfectly formed slugs broken into granules. The granules can be lubricated to prevent sticking to the tablet-forming dies by means of the addition of stearic acid, a stearate salt, talc or mineral oil. The lubricated mixture is then compressed into tablets. The compounds of the present invention can also be combined with a free flowing inert carrier and compressed into tablets directly without going through the granulating or slugging steps. A clear or opaque protective coating consisting of a sealing coat of shellac, a coating of sugar or polymeric material, and a polish coating of wax can be provided. Dyestuffs can be added to these coatings to distinguish different unit dosages.

Oral fluids such as solutions, syrups, and elixirs can be prepared in dosage unit form so that a given quantity contains a predetermined amount of the compound. Syrups can be prepared, for example, by dissolving the compound in a suitably flavored aqueous solution, while elixirs are prepared through the use of a non-toxic alcoholic vehicle. Suspensions can be formulated generally by dispersing the compound in a non-toxic vehicle. Solubilizers and emulsifiers such as ethoxylated isostearyl alcohols and polyoxy ethylene sorbitol ethers, preservatives; flavor additives such as peppermint oil, or natural sweeteners, saccharin, or other artificial sweeteners; and the like can also be added.

Where appropriate, dosage unit formulations for oral administration can be microencapsulated. The formulation can also be prepared to prolong or sustain the release as for example by coating or embedding particulate material in polymers, wax or the like.

The compounds may also be coupled with soluble polymers as targetable drug carriers. Such polymers can include polyvinylpyrrolidone (PVP), pyran copolymer, polyhydroxypropylmethacrylamide-phenol, polyhydroxyethyl-aspartamidephenol, or polyethyleneoxidepolylysine substituted with palmitoyl residues. Furthermore, the compounds may be coupled to a class of biodegradable polymers useful in achieving controlled release of a drug; for example, polylactic acid, polyepsilon caprolactone, polyhydroxy butyric acid, polyorthoesters, polyacetals, polydihydropyrans, polycyanoacrylates, and cross-linked or amphipathic block copolymers of hydrogels.

Pharmaceutical formulations adapted for transdermal administration may be presented as discrete patches intended to remain in intimate contact with the epidermis of the recipient for a prolonged period of time. For example, the active ingredient may be delivered from the patch by iontophoresis as generally described in Pharmaceutical Research, 3(6), 318 (1986), incorporated herein by reference as related to such delivery systems.

Pharmaceutical formulations adapted for topical administration may be formulated as ointments, creams, suspensions, lotions, powders, solutions, pastes, gels, sprays, aerosols, or oils.

For treatments of the eye or other external tissues, for example mouth and skin, the formulations may be applied as a topical ointment or cream. When formulated in an ointment, the active ingredient may be employed with either a paraffinic or a water-miscible ointment base. Alternatively, the active ingredient may be formulated in a cream with an oil-in-water cream base or a water-in-oil base.

Pharmaceutical formulations adapted for topical administrations to the eye include eye drops wherein the active ingredient is dissolved or suspended in a suitable carrier, especially an aqueous solvent.

Pharmaceutical formulations adapted for topical administration in the mouth include lozenges, pastilles, and mouthwashes.

Pharmaceutical formulations adapted for nasal administration, where the carrier is a solid, include a coarse powder having a particle size for example in the range 20 to 500 microns. The powder is administered in the manner in which snuff is taken, i.e., by rapid inhalation through the nasal passage from a container of the powder held close up to the nose. Suitable formulations wherein the carrier is a liquid, for administration as a nasal spray or as nasal drops, include aqueous or oil solutions of the active ingredient.

Pharmaceutical formulations adapted for administration by inhalation include fine particle dusts or mists, which may be generated by means of various types of metered dose pressurized aerosols, nebulizers, or insufflators.

Pharmaceutical formulations adapted for rectal administration may be presented as suppositories or as enemas.

Pharmaceutical formulations adapted for vaginal administration may be presented as pessaries, tampons, creams, gels, pastes, foams, or spray formulations.

Pharmaceutical formulations adapted for parenteral administration include aqueous and non-aqueous sterile injection solutions which may contain anti-oxidants, buffers, bacteriostats, and solutes that render the formulation isotonic with the blood of the intended recipient; and aqueous and non-aqueous sterile suspensions which may include suspending agents and thickening agents. The formulations may be presented in unit-dose or multi-dose containers, for example sealed ampules and vials, and may be stored in a freeze-dried (lyophilized) condition requiring only the addition of the sterile liquid carrier, for example water for injections, immediately prior to use. Extemporaneous injection solutions and suspensions may be prepared from sterile powders, granules, and tablets.

In addition to the ingredients particularly mentioned above, the formulations may include other agents conventional in the art having regard to the type of formulation in question. For example, formulations suitable for oral administration may include flavoring or coloring agents.

The compounds of the present invention, their salts, solvates, or physiologically functional derivatives thereof, may be employed alone or in combination with other therapeutic agents. The compound(s) of Formula I or Formula Ia and the other pharmaceutically active agent(s) may be administered together or separately and, when administered separately, administration may occur simultaneously or sequentially, in any order. The amounts of the compound(s) of Formula I or Formula Ia and the other pharmaceutically active agent(s) and the relative timings of administration will be selected in order to achieve the desired combined therapeutic effect. The administration in combination of a compound of Formula I or Formula Ia (salt, solvate, or physiologically functional derivative thereto) with other treatment compounds or agent may be in combination by administration concomitantly in: (1) a unitary pharmaceutical composition including both compounds; or (2) separate pharmaceutical compositions each including one of the compounds. Alternatively, the combination may be administered separately in a sequential manner wherein one treatment agent is administered first and the other second or vice versa. Such sequential administration may be close in time or remote in time.

The compounds of the present invention may be used in the treatment of a variety of disorders and conditions and, as such, the compounds of the present invention may be used in combination with a variety of other suitable therapeutic agents useful in the treatment (including prophylaxis) of obesity and/or associated diseases, disorders, or conditions. More specifically, the present invention includes the treatment (including prophylaxis) of obesity. Other disorders, conditions, and/or diseases associated with obesity can include diabetes, depression (major and bipolar), anxiety, hypertension, drug and substance addiction, and arteriosclerosis.

One aspect of the present invention comprises a compound of Formula I or Formula Ia (a salt, solvate, or physiologically functional derivative thereof) in combination with at least one other species selected from the group consisting of at least one agent or drug for treating obesity, diabetes, hypertension, and arteriosclerosis. In particular, a compound of Formula I or

Formula Ia (a salt, solvate, or physiologically functional derivative thereof) may be combined with at least one species for the treatment of obesity selected from the group of human ciliary neurotropic factor, a CB-1 antagonist or inverse agonist (such as rimonabant), a neurotransmitter reuptake inhibitor (such as sibutramine, bupropion, or bupropion HCl, radafaxine), a lipase inhibitor (such as orlistat), an MC4R agonist, a 5-HT2c agonist, a ghrelin receptor antagonist, a CCK-A receptor agonist, an NPY Y1 antagonist, PYY3-36 and a PPAR activator.

The compounds of this invention may be made by a variety of methods, including well-known standard synthetic methods. Illustrative general synthetic methods are set out below and then specific compounds of the invention are prepared in the working examples.

Those skilled in the art will recognize if a stereocenter exists in compounds of formula (I). Accordingly, the present invention includes all possible stereoisomers and includes not only racemic compounds but the individual enantiomers as well. When a compound is desired as a single enantiomer, such may be obtained by stereospecific synthesis, by resolution of the final product or any convenient intermediate, or by chiral chromatographic methods as are known in the art. Resolution of the final product, an intermediate, or a starting material may be affected by any suitable method known in the art. See, for example, Stereochemistry of Organic Compounds by E. L. Eliel, S. H. Wilen, and L. N. Mander (Wiley-Interscience, 1994), incorporated by reference with regard to stereochemistry.

Processes for Preparing Compounds of Formula I and Formula Ia

In each of the following synthetic descriptions protecting groups for sensitive or reactive groups were employed where necessary in accordance with general principles of synthetic chemistry. Protecting groups are manipulated according to standard methods of organic synthesis (T. W. Green and P. G. M. Wuts (1999) Protecting Groups in Organic Synthesis, 3rd edition, John Wiley and Sons, incorporated by reference with regard to protecting groups). These groups are removed at a convenient stage of the compound synthesis using methods that are readily apparent to those skilled in the art. The selection of processes as well as the reaction conditions and order of their execution shall be consistent with the preparation of the compounds of Formula I and Formula Ia.

In all of the synthetic descriptions that follow, the variables ring A, ring B, D, E, J, R1, R2, R3, R4, m and n are as described for Formula I and Formula Ia unless otherwise noted.

General Methods of Synthesizing Compounds of Formula I and Formula Ia General Method 1:

Bond formation between Formula II and Formula III with nucleophilic substitution/displacement of X by N.

Compounds of Formula I can be prepared by nucleophilic displacement of X from a compound of Formula II with the N of a compound of Formula III. In Formula II, X is a suitable leaving group, for example, a halogen atom (e.g., chloride, bromide or iodide), a triflate, or a tosylate group. The reaction takes place in a suitable organic solvent (e.g., MeOH, EtOH, or acetonitrile) with or without a promoter (e.g. NaI) at a temperature of room temperature to 160° C. using conventional or microwave heating. When NHR3R4 is a salt (e.g., HCL or trifluoroacetate), a base (e.g., Et3N or (iPr)2NEt) is added to the reaction mixture. Compounds of Formula III can be obtained commercially from conventional suppliers such as Aldrich, for example, or can be suitably prepared from commercially available starting materials by one skilled in the art of organic chemistry. Compounds of Formula II can be readily prepared through a Suzuki reaction involving compounds of Formula IV with or without additional synthetic manipulation by means known to one skilled in the art of organic chemistry.

General Method 2:

Bond Formation between Formula IV and Formula V.

Compounds of Formula I can be prepared by reaction of a compound of Formula IV where X is a leaving group (eg. halogen, or triflate) with a compound of Formula V where Z is a boronate, boronic acid, halogen, or triflate, for example, and R3 could be a protecting group which is later removed in a separate step. The reaction occurs under Suzuki reaction conditions in a suitable organic solvent such as acetonitrile, in the presence of a suitable catalyst such as (Ph3P)4Pd or PdCl2(dppf), and in the presence of an inorganic base such as Na2CO3 with or without the addition of water at a temperature ranging from room temperature to 100° C.

General Method 3:

Bond cleavage between N and R4 of Formula VI by deprotection as of a basic amine as last step.

Compounds of Formula I can be readily prepared from compounds of Formula VI, which may have been rendered using a similar procedure as described in General Method 2, wherein R3 of Formula V is now a suitable protecting group (ie. Boc). The protecting group is then removed using known literature procedures to produce a compound of Formula I wherein R3 is —H.

General Method 4:

Bond formation between Formula VII and a ketone or aldehyde by reductive alkylation of NHR3.

Compounds of Formula I can be prepared from compounds of Formula VII by reductive alkylation with a ketone or aldehyde in a suitable solvent such as MeOH or CH2Cl2, in the presence of a reducing agent such as sodium cyanoborohydride, sodium (triacetoxy)borohydride or PS—BH3CN, with or without acetic acid, at a temperature from room temperature to 50° C. Sometimes it was found to be advantageous to react compounds of Formula VII where R3 is H, with the ketone or aldehyde in a suitable solvent such as benzene or toluene, at reflux temperature, under Dean-Stark conditions before the addition of the reducing agent. In this procedure R5 and R6 may together form a ketone; or when R5 is hydrogen, R5 and R6 may form an aldehyde.

Compounds of Formula Ia can be prepared in a similar manner using the reductive alkylation conditions described. Compounds of Formula VIIIa can be prepared via Suzuki coupling between a compound of formula IV where X is a leaving group (eg. halogen, or triflate) and an appropriately substituted tetrahydroisoquinoline derivative where Z is a boronate, boronic acid, halogen, or triflate, for example, and R3 could be a protecting group which is later removed in a separate step. The reaction occurs under Suzuki reaction conditions in a suitable organic solvent such as acetonitrile, in the presence of a suitable catalyst such as (Ph3P)4Pd or PdCl2(dppf), and in the presence of an inorganic base such as Na2CO3 with or without the addition of water at a temperature ranging from room temperature to 100° C.

General Method 5:

Bond formation between Formula IX and Formula III by reductive alkylation

Compounds of Formula I, where D is CH2 and J is a bond, can be prepared from compounds of Formula IX by reaction with compounds of Formula III in the presence of a reducing agent such as NaCN(BH)3, NaBH(OAc)3 or PS—BH3CN, in an appropriate organic solvent such as MeOH or dichloromethane, with or without acetic acid, at a temperature ranging from room temperature to 50° C. Sometimes it was found advantageous to react the compound of Formula IX with the compound of Formula III in a suitable solvent such as benzene or toluene, at reflux temperature, using Dean-Stark conditions prior to the addition of the reducing agent.

General Method 6:

Functional group interconversion(s) to unmask E from Y in Formula X. Compounds of Formula I can be prepared by hydrolysis of a nitrile to carboxamide (Y=CN, E=CONH2) or aminolysis of an ester to carboxamide (Y=CO2R, E=CONH2).

General Method 7:

Removal of protecting group from Compounds of Formula X wherein Y is a suitably protected heteroaryl or heterocyclyl. Compounds of Formula I can be readily prepared from compounds of Formula X by removal of a protecting group (ie. POM, SEM, or Boc) using known literature procedures. Compounds of Formula X can be prepared using a method described herein or through synthetic methods known to one skilled in the art of organic chemistry.

Experimental

Reverse phase chromatography was performed on an Agilent 1100 series instrument using a Phenomenex Luna 5 micron C18 column (150×21.1 mm). The gradient was 50% to 90% acetonitrile containing 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid/water containing 0.1% trifluoroacetic acid. Normal phase chromatography was performed on the ISCO Sg 100c combiflash system.

Intermediate A-1-1 3′-hydroxy-4-biphenylcarboxamide

A mixture of 4-benzamide boronic acid (1.0 g, 0.006 mol), 3-bromophenol (1.0 g, 0.006 mol) and 30 mL of 0.4M Na2CO3 in 30 mL of acetonitrile was degassed for 10 min. with nitrogen. Tetrakis(triphenylphosphine)palladium (0.04 g, 0.03 mmol) was added and the mixture was placed in a preheated oil bath at 90° C. After 2.5 hr the hot reaction mixture was filtered through celite and concentrated to one-half volume in vacuo. The residue was extracted with mixtures of ethyl acetate and dichloromethane. The combined organic extracts were dried (Na2SO4), filtered and concentrated in vacuo to give 3′-hydroxy-4-biphenylcarboxamide as a tan solid. (M+H) 214, tR 1.8 min. (LC/MS method A). This product was used without further purification.

TABLE A Synthesis of Intermediates of Formula II Example # Structure and Name Characterization Data Comments D-1-1 LC/MS (Method A) tR 1.77 min (M + H) 214 Prepared in a manner similar to A-1-1 using 3-benzamide boronic acid and 4- bromophenol1) H-1-1 (M + H) 214, tR 1.86 min (LC/MS Method A) Prepared in a manner similar to A-1-1 using 3-benzamide boronic acid and 3- bromophenol J-1-1 (M + H) 214, tR 1.82 min (LC/MS Method A) Prepared in a manner similar to A-1-1 using 4-benzamide boronic acid and 4- bromophenol L-1-2 (M + H) 228, tR 1.94 min (LC/MS Method A) Prepared in a manner similar to A-1-1 using Intermediate IV-4 and 3-hydroxyphenyl boronic acid N-1-2 (M + H) 232, tR 1.88 min (LC/MS Method A) Prepared in a manner similar to A-1-1 using Intermediate IV-5 and 3-hydroxyphenyl boronic acid O-1-1 (M + H) 232, tR 1.88 min (LC/MS Method A) Prepared in a manner similar to A-1-1 using 4-benzamideboronic acid and 3-bromo-4- fluorophenol HH-1-1 (M + H) 215, tR 1.49 min (LC/MS method A) Prepared in a manner similar to A-1-1 using 6-chloro-3- pyridinecarboxamide and 3-hydroxyphenyl boronic acid JJ-1-1 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 6.85 (d, 2 H) 7.60 (m, 3 H) 8.20 (s, 1 H) 8.39 (s, 1 H) 8.90 (d, 2H) 9.72 (s, 1 H) Prepared in a manner similar to A-1-1 using 5-bromo-3- pyridinecarboxamide and 4-hydroxyphenyl boronic acid1) KK-1-1 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.38 (t, 3 H), 4.35 (q, 2 H) 6.85 (d, 2 H) 7.17 (s, 1 H) 7.56 (d, 2 H) 7.74 (s, 1 H) Prepared in a manner similar A-1-1 using ethyl 5-chloro-2- thiophenecarboxylate and 4-hydroxy phenylboronic acid1) KK-2-3 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.23 (t, 6 H), 1.40 (t, 3 H), 3.65 (m, 2 H), 3.78 (m, 2 H), 4.08 (d, 2 H), 4.36 (q, 2 H) 4.85 (t, 1 H) 6.90 (m, 1 H) 7.20-7.36 (m, 4 H) 7.76 (s, 1 H) Note 2 LL-1-3 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 6.88 (m, 1 H), 7.30 (m, 1 H), 7.40 (m, 2 H), 7.61 (s, 1 H), 7.80 (s, 1 H), 8.22 (s, 1 H), 9.78 (s, 1 H) Prepared in a manner similar A-1-1 using Intermediate IV-18 and 3- hydroxyphenylboronic acid1) Note 1: DME was used as the solvent in lieu of Acetonitrile. Note 2: Prepared in a manner similar to A-1-1 using a mixture of ethyl 5-chloro-2-thiophenecarboxylate and (3-{[2,2-Bis(ethyloxy)ethyl]oxy}phenyl)boronic acid2) (prepared according to the procedure in Dack, Kevin Neil; Fray, Michael Jonathan; Whitlock, Gavin Alistair; Lewis, Mark Llewellyn; Thomson, Nicholas Murray: WO 2000/074681).

Compounds of Formula II

Example II-1 3′-[(2-chloroethyl)oxy]-4-biphenylcarboxamide and 3′-[(2-bromoethyl)oxy]-4-biphenylcarboxamide

Into three separate microwave vials was distributed equally a mixture of 3′-hydroxy-4-biphenylcarboxamide (Intermediate A-1-1) (1.0 g, 0.005 mol), 1-bromo-2-chloroethane (2.8 g, 0.02 mol) and potassium carbonate (2.8 g, 0.02 mol) in ethanol (2.2 mL) and water (1.8 mL) was placed in a microwave at 150° C. until the reaction was complete as determined by LC/MS. The contents of the vials were combined and diluted with ethyl acetate and water. The aqueous phase was extracted with ethyl acetate. The combined organic phase was dried (Na2SO4), filtered and concentrated in vacuo to give 3′-[(2-chloroethyl)oxy]-4-biphenylcarboxamide and 3′-[(2-bromoethyl)oxy]-4-biphenylcarboxamide as an off-white solid. LC/MS indicates that this product is a mixture of the chloroethoxy (M+H) 276, 2.34 min. (LC/MS method A) and the bromoethoxy (M+H) 320, tR 2.42 min. in a ratio of ˜81/19% respectively. This product was used without further purification.

Example II-2 3′-[(2-chloroethyl)oxy]-4-biphenylcarboxamide

The title compound was prepared in a manner similar to that described for Example A-1-1 using a mixture of 4-benzamide boronic acid and 3-bromophenyl 2-chloroethylether. (M+H) 276, tR 2.32 min. (LC/MS method A).

Example II-3 4′-[(2-chloroethyl)oxy]-3-biphenylcarboxamide and 4′-[(2-bromoethyl)oxy]-3-biphenylcarboxamide

The mixture of title compounds was prepared similar to Example II-1 using 4′-hydroxy-3-biphenyl carboxamide (Intermediate D-1-1). The chloroethoxy (M+H) 276, tR 2.35 min. (LC/MS method A) and the bromoethoxy (M+H) 320, tR 2.44 min. were obtained in a ratio of ˜84/16% respectively.

Example II-4 4′-[(2-chloroethyl)oxy]-3-biphenylcarboxamide

The title compound was prepared in a manner similar to Example A-1-1 using a mixture of 3-benzamide boronic acid and 4-bromophenyl 2-chloroethylether with PdCl2(dppf).CH2Cl2 in lieu of Pd(PPh3)4 in DME. Purification of the desired product was accomplished by either recrystallization from EtOH or silica gel chromatography using Hexanes/Ethyl Acetate. (LC/MS Method A) tR 2.33 min, m/z 276 (M+H).

Example II-5 3′-[(2-chloroethyl)oxy]-3-biphenylcarboxamide and 3′-[2-bromoethyl)oxy]-3-biphenylcarboxamide

The mixture of title compounds was prepared similar to Example II-1 using 3′-hydroxy-3-biphenylcarboxamide (Intermediate H-1-1). The chloroethoxy (M+H) 276, tR 2.38 min. (LC/MS method A) and the bromoethoxy (M+H) 320, tR 2.45 min. (LC/MS method A) were obtained in a ratio of −65/35% respectively.

Example II-6 4′-[(2-chloroethyl)oxy]-4-biphenylcarboxamide and 4′-[(2-bromo ethyl)oxy]-4-biphenylcarboxamide

The mixture of title compounds was prepared similar to Example II-1 using 4′-hydroxy-4-biphenylcarboxamide (Intermediate J-1-1). LC/MS of the brown solid indicates that this product is a mixture of the chloroethoxy (M+H) 276, tR 2.47 min. (LC/MS method A) and the bromoethoxy (M+H) 320, tR 2.54 min. (LC/MS method A) in a ratio of −74/26% respectively.

Example II-7 3′-[(2-chloroethyl)oxy]-2-methyl-4-biphenylcarboxamide and 3′-[(2-bromo ethyl)oxy]-2-methyl-4-biphenylcarboxamide

The mixture of title compounds was prepared similar to Example II-1 using 3′-hydroxy-2-methyl-4-biphenyl carboxamide (Intermediate L-1-2). LC/MS indicates that this product is a mixture of the chloroethoxy (M+H) 290.2, tR 2.42 min. (LC/MS method A) and the bromoethoxy (M+H) 334, tR 2.50 min. (LC/MS method A) in a ratio of −73/27% respectively.

Example II-8 3′-[(2-chloroethyl)oxy]-2-methyl-4-biphenylcarboxamide

A mixture of 3′-hydroxy-2-methyl-4-biphenylcarboxamide (1.65 g, 0.007 mol. Intermediate L-1-2), 2-chloroethyl-p-toluenesulfate (1.88 g, 0.008 mol) and potassium carbonate (1.11 g, 0.008 mol) in acetonitrile (25 mL) was heated at reflux for 40 hr. The reaction mixture was concentrated in vacuo to remove acetonitrile. The residue was partitioned between ethyl acetate and water. The ethyl acetate phase was washed with brine, dried (Na2SO4), filtered and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by silica gel chromatography to give 3′-[(2-chloroethyl)oxy]-2-methyl-4-biphenylcarboxamide as a white solid. (M+H) 290, tR 2.49 min. (LC/MS method B).

Example II-9 3′-[(2-chloroethyl)oxy]-2-fluoro-4-biphenylcarboxamide and 3′-[(2-bromo ethyl)oxy]-2-fluoro-4-biphenylcarboxamide

The mixture of title compounds was prepared similar to Example II-1 using 2-fluoro-3′-hydroxy-4-biphenyl carboxamide (Intermediate N-1-2). LC/MS indicates that this product is a mixture of the chloroethoxy (M+H) 294, tR 2.41 min. (LC/MS method A) and the bromoethoxy (M+H) 338, 2.49 min. (LC/MS method A) in a ratio of −65/35% respectively.

Example II-10 5′-[(2-chloroethyl)oxy]-2′-fluoro-4-biphenylcarboxamide and 5′-[(2-bromo ethyl)oxy]-2′-fluoro-4-biphenylcarboxamide

The mixture of title compounds was prepared similar to Example II-1 using 2′-fluoro-5′-hydroxy-4-biphenyl carboxamide (Intermediate O-1-1). LC/MS indicates that this product is a mixture of the chloroethoxy (M+H) 294, tR 2.38 min. (LC/MS method A) and the bromoethoxy (M+H) 338, tR 2.45 min. (LC/MS method A) in a ratio of −74/26% respectively.

Example II-11 3′-[(3-chloropropyl)oxy]-4-biphenylcarboxamide and 3′-[(3-bromo propyl)oxy]-4-biphenylcarboxamide

The mixture of title compounds was prepared similar to Example II-1 using 3′-hydroxy-4-biphenylcarboxamide (Intermediate A-1-1) and 1-bromo-3-chloropropane. LC/MS indicates that this product is a mixture of the chloropropoxy (M+H) 290, tR 2.57 min. (LC/MS method A) and the bromopropoxy (M+H) 334, tR 2.62 min. (LC/MS method A) in a ratio of ˜75/25% respectively.

Example II-12 6-{3-[(2-chloroethyl)oxy]phenyl}-3-pyridinecarboxamide

The title compound was prepared in a manner similar to Example II-8 using 6-(3-hydroxyphenyl)-3-pyridinecarboxamide (Intermediate HH-1-1). 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 3.95 (t, 2H) 4.38 (t, 2H) 7.05 (d, 1H) 7.40 (t, 1H) 7.60 (br, 1H) 7.75 (m, 2H) 8.10 (d, 1H) 8.20 (br, 1H) 8.28 (d, 1H) 9.05 (s, 1H).

Example II-13 5-{4-[(2-chloroethyl)oxy]phenyl}-3-pyridinecarboxamide

The title compound was prepared in a similar fashion to Example II-8 using 5-(4-hydroxyphenyl)-3-pyridinecarboxamide (Intermediate JJ-1-1). 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 3.95 (t, 2H) 4.35 (t, 2H) 7.10 (d, 2H) 7.60 (s, 1H) 7.75 (d, 2H) 8.12 (s, 1H) 8.40 (s, 1H) 8.92 (s, 1H) 8.98 (s, 1H).

Example II-14 5-{4-[(2-chloroethyl)oxy]phenyl}-2-thiophenecarboxamide

To a suspension of ammonium chloride (2.12 g, 39.6 mmol) in 10 ml of toluene at 5° C. was added dropwise 19.8 ml of 2M trimethylaluminum in toluene solution. The mixture was stirred for 2 h at the room temperature and ethyl 5-(4-hydroxyphenyl)-2-thiophene carboxylate (Intermediate KK-1-1) (1.98 g, 7.03 mmol) was added. The resulting mixture was heated at 55-60° C. for 15 h, cooled to 5° C. and quenched with ethanol (10 ml). All solvents were removed in vacuo and the residue was treated with 80 ml of 0.5M HCl solution. A yellow solid was collected by filtration, washed with water and air-dried (1.64 g). The product was added to a mixture of 2-chloroethyl p-toluenesulfonate (4.07 ml, 22.5 mmol) and potassium carbonate (3.11 g, 22.5 mmol) in 100 ml of acetonitrile. After heating at reflux for 40 h, the reaction mixture was filtered to remove the solids, concentrated to dryness in vacuo and purified by silica gel column chromatography using Hexanes and EtOAc to give the title compound as a light yellow solid.

1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 3.90 (t, 2H), 4.28 (t, 2H) 7.00 (d, 2H) 7.39 (m, 2H) 7.60 (m, 3H) 7.90 (s, 1H); (M+H) 282, tR 2.28 min (LC/MS method A).

Example II-15 5-{3-[(2-chloroethyl)oxy]phenyl}-2-thiophenecarboxamide

Step 1: Ethyl 5-{3-[(2-oxoethyl)oxy]phenyl}-2-thiophenecarboxylate

Ethyl 5-(3-{[2,2-bis(ethyloxy)ethyl]oxy}phenyl)-2-thiophenecarboxylate (Intermediate KK-2-3) (1.41 g, 3.87 mmol) was dissolved in 20 ml of chloroform and cooled to 0° C. 5 ml of 50% aqueous trifluoroacetic acid solution was added. The mixture was stirred for 15 h at room temperature and 6 h at 65° C., cooled, diluted with chloroform and neutralized with saturated sodium bicarbonate solution. The organic layer was separated, washed with brine, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by silica gel column chromatography (10 to 50% ethyl acetate in hexanes) to afford the title compound as a white crystalline solid.

1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.40 (t, 3H), 4.38 (q, 2H) 4.63 (s, 2H) 6.85 (m, 1H) 7.24-7.38 (m, 4H) 7.77 (s, 1H), 9.90 (s, 1H).

Step 2: 5-(3-Hydroxyphenyl)-2-thiophenecarboxamide

The mixture of ethyl 5-{3-[(2-oxoethyl)oxy]phenyl}-2-thiophenecarboxylate (1.3 g, 4.48 mmol), 2N aqueous lithium hydroxide solution (5 ml, 10 mmol) and tetrahydrofuran (10 ml) was heated to reflux for 12 h. The reaction mixture was cooled, concentrated in vacuo to remove tetrahydrofuran, acidified to pH1-2 with 2N HCl, and extracted with ethyl acetate three times. The combined extracts were washed with brine, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated in vacuo. The solid residue (0.75 g) was dissolved in dry tetrahydrofuran (15 ml) and cooled to 0° C. (Chloromethylene)dimethylammonium chloride (Aldrich, 0.52 g, 4 mmol) was added in one portion. The mixture was stirred at 0° C. for 4 h. The pre-cooled (0° C.) mixture of 28% ammonium hydroxide aqueous solution (2.5 ml) and water (2.5 ml) was added, and the reaction mixture was stirred at the room temperature. Tetrahydrofuran was removed in vacuo and the residue was extracted with ethyl acetate three times. The combined extracts were washed with brine, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by silica gel column chromatography (80% ethyl acetate in hexanes) to give the title compound as a brown solid.

1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 6.75 (d, 1H) 7.01 (s, 1H) 7.08 (d, 1H) 7.20 (t, 1H) 7.40 (m, 2H) 7.65 (d, 1H) 7.97 (br., 1H) 9.62 (s, 1H); (M+H) 220, tR 1.78 min (LC/MS method A).

Step 3: 5-{3-[(2-Chloroethyl)oxy]phenyl}-2-thiophenecarboxamide

5-(3-Hydroxyphenyl)-2-thiophenecarboxamide (0.31 g, 1.41 mmol), 2-chloroethyl p-toluenesulfonate (1.327 g, 5.65 mmol) and potassium carbonate (0.782 g, 5.65 mmol) in 20 ml of acetonitrile were heated to reflux for 15 h. The reaction mixture was concentrated in vacuo and purified by silica gel column chromatography (50 to 80% ethyl acetate in hexanes) to give the title compound as a white solid.

1H NMR (400 MHz, Acetone-d6) δ ppm 3.95 (t, 2H) 4.40 (t, 2H) 6.68 (br., 1H) 7.00 (d, 1H) 7.28-7.40 (m, 3H) 7.50 (d, 1H) 7.72 (d, 1H).

Example II-16 2-{3-[(2-chloroethyl)oxy]phenyl}-1,3-thiazole-4-carboxamide

The title compound was prepared in a similar fashion to Example II-8 using 2-(3-Hydroxyphenyl)-1,3-thiazole-4-carboxamide (Intermediate LL-1-3). (M+H) 283, tR 2.34 min (LC/MS method A).

Example II-17 2-{4-[(2-chloroethyl)oxy]phenyl}-1,3-thiazole-4-carboxamide

Step 1: 2-(4-Hydroxyphenyl)-1,3-thiazole-4-carboxylic Acid

4-Hydroxybenzenecarbothioamide (1.53 g, 10 mmol) and potassium hydroxide (1.50 g, 26.8 mmol) were dissolved in a mixture of 60 ml of water and 15 ml of methanol. A solution of bromopyruvic acid (1.67 g, 10 mmol) in 10 ml of methanol was added dropwise at room temperature. The resulting mixture was heated to reflux for 1.5 h, cooled to room temperature, poured into 100 ml of water and adjusted with 0.2N HCl solution to pH2. The mixture was placed in a refrigerator for 15 h. The title compound was obtained by filtration as a brown solid.

1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 6.82 (d, 2H), 7.78 (d, 2H), 8.37 (s, 1H), 10.05 (s, 1H), 13.00 (s, 1H).

Step 2: 2-(4-Hydroxyphenyl)-1,3-thiazole-4-carboxamide

2-(4-Hydroxyphenyl)-1,3-thiazole-4-carboxylic acid (0.835 g, 3.77 mmol) was dissolved in 20 ml of dry tetrahydrofuran and cooled to 0° C. (Chloromethylene)dimethylammonium chloride (0.58 g, 4.53 mmol) was added in one portion. The mixture was stirred at 0° C. for 5 h. 28% Ammonium hydroxide aqueous solution (5 ml) was added, and the reaction mixture was stirred for 15 h at the room temperature. The organic solvent was removed in vacuo and the residue was partitioned between ethyl acetate and saturated sodium carbonate solution. The organic layer was separated and the aqueous phase was extracted twice with ethyl acetate. The combined extracts were washed with brine, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by silica gel column chromatography (0 to 10% methanol in dichloromethane) to give the title compound as beige solid.

1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 6.83 (d, 2H) 7.60 (s, 1H) 7.80 (m, 3H) 8.12 (s, 1H) 10.05 (s, 1H); (M+H) 221, tR 1.69 min (LC/MS method A).

Step 3: 2-{4-[(2-Chloroethyl)oxy]phenyl}-1,3-thiazole-4-carboxamide

Proceeding in a similar manner to Example II-8 using 2-(4-hydroxyphenyl)-1,3-thiazole-4-carboxamide gave the title compound as a yellow solid.

1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 3.82 (t, 2H) 4.30 (t, 2H) 5.68 (s, 1H) 7.00 (d, 2H) 7.28 (s, 1H) 7.90 (d, 2H) 8.09 (s, 1H)

Compounds of Formula III

Example III-1 4,4-dimethylcyclohexylamine hydrochloride

Prepared similarly to the procedure of Johnston, T. P.; McCaleb, G. S.; Opliger, P. S.; Laster, W. R.; Montgomery J. A. J. Med. Chem. 1971, 14 (7), 600.

Step 1: 4,4-Dimethylcyclohexanone

A mixture of 4,4-dimethyl-2-cyclohexene-1-one (5.5 g) and 10% Pd/C (0.25 g, wet, Degussa type E101) in EtOAc (50 mL) was hydrogenated under 15 psi for 3 h at room temperature. The mixture was filtered through Celite and the filtrate was concentrated in vacuo affording the title compound as a colorless solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.07 (s, 6H), 1.65 (t, J=7 Hz, 4H), 2.35 (t, J=7 Hz, 4H).

Step 2: 4,4-dimethylcyclohexanone oxime

To a solution of 4,4-dimethylcyclohexanone (3.0 g, 0.024 mole) and hydroxylamine hydrochloride (2.2 g, 0.031 mole) in ethanol (15 mL) and water (20 mL) at room temperature was added a solution of sodium carbonate (3.3 g, 0.031 mol) in water (10 mL), dropwise. The mixture was heated under reflux for 3 hr, cooled to room temperature and ethanol was removed in vacuo. The aqueous residue was extracted several times with ethyl acetate, combined extracts were dried over MgSO4 and concentrated in vacuo affording the title compound as a white solid, used without further purification. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 0.93 (s, 6H), 1.28 (t, J=6.6 Hz, 2H), 1.35 (t, J=6.6 Hz, 2H), 2.11 (t, J=6.6 Hz, 2H), 2.36 (t, J=6.6 Hz, 2H), 10.12 (s, 1H).

Step 3: 4,4-dimethylcyclohexylamine hydrochloride

A mixture of 4,4-dimethylcyclohexanone oxime (3.0 g, 0.021 mole) and Raney 2800 Nickel (0.8 g, slurry in water) in ethanol (100 mL) was hydrogenated under 50 psig H2 using a Parr hydrogenation apparatus. After hydrogen absorption ceased the mixture was filtered through Celite. To the filtrate was added a solution of HCl in Et2O (50 mL of a 1M solution), the mixture was concentrated in vacuo. The residue was triturated with diethyl ether, solid was collected by filtration, washed with diethyl ether and air dried to give the title compound as a white solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 0.86 (s, 3H), 0.87 (s, 3H), 1.19 (m, 2H), 1.36 (m, 2H), 1.48 (m, 2H), 1.70 (m, 2H), 2.87 (m, 1H), 7.93 (br. s, 3H).

Example III-2 [(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)methyl]amine hydrochloride

Step 1: (4,4-dimethylcyclohexylidene)methyl methyl ether

To a mixture of methoxymethyl triphenylphosphonium chloride (35.5 g, 0.104 mol) in THF (400 mL) at 0° C. was added n-BuLi (33.1 mL of a 2.8M solution in hexanes; 0.095 mol). The mixture was stirred at 0° C. for 30 min., cooled to −78° C. and a solution of 4,4-dimethyl cyclohexanone (10.0 g, 0.079 mol) in THF (100 mL) was added, dropwise. After 1 hr at −78° C. the mixture was slowly warmed to 0° C., diluted with satd ammonium chloride (400 mL) and ethyl acetate (100 mL) and stirred at room temperature for 48 hr. Layers were separated and the aqueous phase was extracted with ethyl acetate. Combined organics were washed with brine, dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was triturated with hexanes, solids were removed by filtration and the filtrated was concentrated in vacuo. The residue was dissolved in dichloromethane (40 mL), PS-TsNHNH2 (8 g; ca. 3.7 mmol/g) and acetic acid (2 drops) were added and the mixture was stirred at room temperature for 24 hr. Resin was removed by filtration and washed (CH2Cl2, MeOH, CH2Cl2). Combined filtrate/washings were concentrated in vacuo, affording (4,4-dimethyl cyclohexylidene)methyl methyl ether as an oil.

1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 0.91 (s, 6H); 1.27 (m, 5H); 1.95 (m, 2H); 2.18 (m, 2H); 3.52 (s, 3H).

Step 2: 4,4-dimethylcyclohexanecarbaldehyde

A solution of (4,4-dimethyl cyclohexylidene)methyl methyl ether (6.7 g, 0.043 mol) in THF (200 mL) containing 6M HCl (aq) (60 mL) was stirred at room temperature for 24 hr. The reaction mixture was diluted with a mixture of ethyl ether, hexanes, brine and water. The mixture was separated and the aqueous phase was extracted with ethyl ether. The combined organic phase was washed with brine, dried over Na2SO4, and concentrated in vacuo, affording 4,4-dimethylcyclohexanecarbaldehyde as a yellow oil, used without further purification.

Step 3: [(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)methyl](phenylmethyl)amine

A solution of 4,4-dimethylcyclohexanecarbaldehyde (6.6 g, 0.047 mol), benzylamine (5.0 g, 0.047 mol) and acetic acid (1 mL) in methanol (60 mL) was stirred for 30 min at room temperature. Sodium triacetoxyborohydride (10.0 g, 0.047 mol) was added in one portion and the mixture was stirred at room temperature for 16 hr. The reaction mixture was concentrated in vacuo and partitioned between dichloromethane and water. The organic phase was washed with brine, silica gel was added and the mixture was concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (CH2Cl2/MeOH), affording [(4,4-dimethyl cyclohexyl)methyl](phenylmethyl)amine as a white solid. (M+H) 232, 1.76 min. (LC/MS method B).

Step 4: [(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)methyl]amine hydrochloride

A mixture of [(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)methyl](phenylmethyl)amine (4.37 g, 0.019 mol) and 10% Pd/C (50% w/w with water) (0.75 g) in ethanol (100 mL) was hydrogenated under 50 psi H2 using a Parr hydrogenation apparatus for 24 h and filtered through Celite. To the filtrate was added HCl in Et2O (30 mL of a 1M solution) and the mixture was concentrated in vacuo. The residue was triturated with Et2O, filtered, washed (Et2O) and dried to give [(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)methyl]amine hydrochloride as a white solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 0.83 (s, 3H); 0.86 (s, 3H); 1.11 (m, 4H); 1.33 (m, 2H); 1.46 (m, 1H); 1.53 (m, 2H); 2.64 (br s, 2H); 7.91 (br s, 3H).

Example III-3 rac 3,3-dimethylcyclohexylamine hydrochloride

The title compound was prepared from 3,3-dimethylcyclohexanone in a manner similar to Example III-1 steps 2-3, with the exception that the intermediate oxime was not characterized.

1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 0.85 (s, 3H); 0.90 (s, 3H); 0.97-1.16 (m, 3H); 1.29 (br d, 1H); 1.34-1.46 (m, 1H); 1.53-1.63 (m, 2H); 1.90 (br d, 1H); 3.05 (m, 1H); 7.99 (br s, 3H).

Example III-4 [(1S)-3,3-dimethylcyclohexyl]amine hydrochloride and [(1R)-3,3-dimethylcyclohexyl]amine hydrochloride

Step 1: rac-phenylmethyl (3,3-dimethylcyclohexyl)carbamate

To a solution of (3,3-dimethylcyclohexyl)amine hydrochloride (10.0 g, 0.060 mol) and N,N-diisopropylethylamine (15.8 g, 0.12 mol) in acetonitrile (125 mL) at ice bath temperature was added a solution of benzyl chloroformate (11.4 g, 0.067 mol) in acetonitrile (25 mL), dropwise. The mixture was stirred overnight, gradually warming to ambient temperature, and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was partitioned between ethyl acetate/5% citric acid solution and the layers were separated. The organic layer was washed with brine, dried over Na2SO4, adsorbed onto silica gel and purified by flash chromatography (CH2Cl2/hexanes) affording the title compound as a colorless oil. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm: 0.85 (s, 6H), 0.92-1.02 (m, 3H), 1.25 (d, 1H), 1.36-1.52 (m, 3H), 1.76 (br. d, 1H), 3.36-3.44 (m, 1H), 4.96 (s, 2H), 7.10 (d, 1H), 7.27-7.36 (m, 5H).

Step 2: phenylmethyl [(1S)-3,3-dimethylcyclohexyl]carbamate and phenylmethyl [(1R)-3,3-dimethylcyclohexyl]carbamate

rac-Phenylmethyl (3,3-dimethylcyclohexyl)carbamate (11.2 g) was separated into enantiomers on a 30 mm Chiralpak AS column by supercritical fluid chromatography (CO2/EtOH, 75:4 g/min respectively at 140 bar, 40° C.). Earlier-eluting enantiomer: 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm: 0.85 (s, 6H), 0.93-1.01 (m, 3H), 1.25 (d, 1H), 1.33-1.52 (m, 3H), 1.75 (br d, 1H), 3.35-3.44 (m, 1H), 4.96 (s, 2H), 7.08 (d, 1H), 7.25-7.35 (m, 5H). Later-eluting enantiomer: 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm: 0.85 (s, 6H), 0.92-1.01 (m, 3H), 1.25 (d, 1H), 1.33-1.52 (m, 3H), 1.75 (br dl 1H), 3.36-3.44 (m, 1H), 4.96 (s, 2H), 7.08 (d, 1H), 7.26-7.35 (m, 5H). Comparison of experimentally measured vibrational circular dichroism (VCD) spectra with the calculated (ab initio)VCD spectrum for [(1R)-3,3-dimethylcyclohexyl]carbamate indicated the later-eluting enantiomer had the (R)-configuration.

Step 3: [(1S)-3,3-dimethylcyclohexyl]amine hydrochloride and [(1R)-3,3-dimethylcyclohexyl]amine hydrochloride

The preparation of [(1S)-3,3-dimethylcyclohexyl]amine hydrochloride is given as representative. Phenylmethyl [(1S)-3,3-dimethylcyclohexyl]carbamate (1.0 g, 4.0 mmol) and 10% Pd/C (0.15 g) in 10 mL of MeOH was stirred under an atmosphere of H2 for 24 hours and filtered through Celite. To the filtrate was added HCl in Et2O (2.5 mL of a 1M solution), the mixture was aged overnight at room temperature and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was triturated with Et2O, solid was collected by filtration washed (Et2O) and dried in vacuo affording the title compound as a white solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm: 0.89 (s, 3H), 0.93 (s, 3H), 1.00-1.17 (m, 3H), 1.33 (br. d, 1H), 1.38-1.49 (br. q, 1H), 1.58-1.63 (m, 2H), 1.92 (br d, 1H), 3.06-3.14 (m, 1H), 7.86 (s, 3H). [(1R)-3,3-dimethylcyclohexyl]amine hydrochloride was obtained from [(1R) 3,3-dimethylcyclohexyl]carbamate according to the procedure described above for [(1S)-3,3-dimethylcyclohexyl]amine hydrochloride. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm: 0.85 (s, 3H), 0.90 (s, 3H), 0.96-1.14 (m, 3H), 1.29 (br. d, 1H), 1.35-1.45 (br q., 1H), 1.53-1.61 (m, 2H), 1.89 (br d, 1H), 3.02-3.09 (m, 1H), 7.88 (s, 3H).

Example III-5 3,3,5,5-tetramethycyclohexylamine hydrochloride

The title compound was prepared from 3,3,5,5-tetramethylcyclohexanone in a manner similar to Example III-1 steps 2-3, with the exception that the intermediate oxime was not characterized.

1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 0.89 (s, 6H); 0.96 (s, 6H); 0.92-1.12 (m, 3H); 1.22 (br d, 1H); 1.67 (br s, 2H); 3.24 (m, 1H); 8.01 (br s, 3H).

Example III-6 isohexylamine hydrobromide

Step 1: 2-(4-methylpentyl)-1H-isoindole-1,3(2H)-dione

To a solution of 1-bromo-4-methylpentane (5.0 g, 0.030 mol) in DMF (20 mL) was added potassium phthalimide (5.9 g, 0.032 mol) in one portion at room temperature. After stirring at room temperature of 1 hr, the mixture was heated at 55° C. for 16 hr. Chloroform (30 mL) was added to the reaction mixture and the resulting mixture was poured into water (100 mL). The aqueous phase was extracted with chloroform and the combined organic phase was washed with 0.25 M NaOH (aq) and water. The organic phase was dried (Na2SO4), filtered and concentrated in vacuo to give 2-(4-methylpentyl)-1H-isoindole-1,3(2H)-dione as a pale yellow oil. (M+H) 232, 2.80 min. (LC/MS method A).

Step 2: isohexylamine hydrobromide

A solution of 2-(4-methylpentyl)-1H-isoindole-1,3(2H)-dione (6.5 g, 0.028 mol) in 48% aqueous hydrogen bromide (10 mL) and acetic acid (25 mL) was heated under reflux for 28 hr. The hot reaction mixture was diluted water (40 mL), chilled in an ice bath and aged at room temperature for 18 hr. Precipitated solids were separated by filtration, and the filtrate was concentrated the in vacuo Residue from the filtrate was triturated with water, insoluble solids were separated by filtration and the filtrate was concentrated in vacuo. Residue from the filtrate was triturated with ether, solids were collected by filtration, washed with ether and dried to give the title compound as a beige solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 0.84 (d, 3H); 0.96 (s, 3H); 1.16 (m, 2H); 1.50 (m, 3H); 2.73 (m, 2H); 7.68 (br s, 3H).

Example III-7 2-cyclohexylethylamine hydrochloride

A mixture of 2-(1-cyclohexenyl)ethylamine (5.60 g) and 10% Pd/C (0.6 g, wet, Degussa type E101) in 60 mL of methanol was hydrogenated under 55 psi H2 using a Parr hydrogenation apparatus for 5 h at room temperature. The mixture was filtered through Celite and the filtrate was concentrated in vacuo. The residue was dissolved in CH2Cl2 (5 mL) and HCl in Et2O (3 mL of a 1M solution) was added. Solid was collected by filtration, affording the title compound as a white solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 0.85 (m, 2H), 1.02-1.36 (m, 5H), 1.41 (m, 2H), 1.55-1.76 (m, 4H), 2.75 (m, 2H), 7.90 (br, 3H).

Example III-8 (2-cyclohexyl-2,2-difluoroethyl)amine hydrochloride

Step 1: ethyl cyclohexyl(oxo)acetate

To a suspension of magnesium turnings (2.20 g, 90.32 mmol) in THF (100 mL) was added cyclohexyl bromide (9.27 mL, 75.27 mmol). The mixture was sonicated (note 1) for 30 min, the supernatant liquid was decanted into an addition funnel and added to a solution of diethyloxalate (22.0 g, 146.14 mmol) in THF (240 mL) at −10° C. over one hour. After 30 minutes, 10% HCl (75 mL) was added the mixture was and stirred 15 minutes. Layers were separated and the aqueous layer was extracted with Et2O (100 mL). Combined organics were washed (brine), dried over Na2SO4, and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a clear oil. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.15-1.40 (m, 5H) 1.56-1.94 (m, 8H) 2.97-3.05 (m, 1H) 4.30 (q, J=7.32 Hz, 2H).

Note 1: A conventional ultrasonic cleaning bath was used.

Step 2: ethyl cyclohexyl(difluoro)acetate

To a solution of ethyl cyclohexyl(oxo)acetate (2.94 g, 15.95 mmol) in 5 mL CH2Cl2 at −5° C. was added bis(2-methoxyethyl)aminosulfur trifluoride (deoxo-fluor; 5.0 mL, 27 mmol) in 5 mL CH2Cl2. EtOH (0.185 mL, 0.78 mmol) was added, the mixture was stirred 16 hours at ambient temperature and poured onto ice. The layers were separated and the aqueous layer was extracted with CH2Cl2 (10 mL). Combined organics were washed (satd NaHCO3, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a clear oil. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.13-1.37 (m, 5H) 1.48-1.85 (m, 8H) 1.98-2.08 (m, 1H) 4.30 (q, J=7.08 Hz, 2H).

Step 3: 2-cyclohexyl-2,2-difluoroacetamide

A solution of ethyl cyclohexyl(difluoro)acetate (2.63 g, 12.75 mmol) in EtOH (6 mL) was sparged with anhyd ammonia for 15 minutes at ambient temperature. The mixture was sealed in a pressure tube and allowed to stand overnight. Volatiles were removed in vacuo and the solid residue was recrystallized from dichloromethane-hexanes affording the title compound as a waxy solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.13-1.37 (m, 5H) 1.48-1.85 (m, 8H) 1.98-2.08 (m, 1H) 4.30 (q, J=7.08 Hz, 2H)

Step 4: (2-cyclohexyl-2,2-difluoroethyl)amine hydrochloride

To a solution of the 2-cyclohexyl-2,2-difluoroacetamide in 20 mL of THF at ambient temperature, under nitrogen, was added borane-tetrahydrofuran complex (56 mL, 56 mmol). The mixture was heated under reflux for 18 hours, cooled to ambient temperature, and MeOH was added slowly, with stirring. The mixture was heated under reflux for 30 minutes, cooled and concentrated in vacuo. Aq. HCl (5 mL, 6M) was added, the mixture was heated briefly (ca. 1 min) under reflux and cooled. The mixture pH was adjusted to ca. 10 with satd NaHCO3 and the whole was extracted with CH2Cl2 (×2). Combined extracts were dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was taken up in EtOH and briefly sparged with a stream of anhyd HCl (ca. 1 min). Precipitated solid was collected by filtration and air-dried affording the title compound as a white solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 1.04-1.25 (m, 5H) 1.56-1.65 (m, 1H) 1.67-1.81 (m, 4H) 1.87-1.98 (m, 1H) 3.35 (t, J=16.4 Hz, 2H) 8.37 (br. s, 2H).

Example III-9 5,6-difluoro-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine (and Corresponding Hydrochloride Salt)

Step 1: 5,6-difluoro-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-1-one

To a solution of 3,4-difluorophenyl propionic acid (30.45 g; 163.6 mmol) and 2 drops of DMF in CH2Cl2 (200 mL) was added oxalyl chloride (41.4 g, 327 mmol) over 20 min. The resulting solution was stirred for 24 hr and concentrated in vacuo (chased 1×PhMe, ca. 100 mL). The residue was dissolved in CS2 (300 mL), cooled to 0° C. and AlCl3 (76.4 g, 573 mmol) was added over 10 min. The mixture was stirred 30 min at 0° C., then heated under reflux for 4 hr. Upon cooling to room temperature the solution was carefully poured onto crushed ice, the carbon disulfide layer was separated and the aqueous layer extracted with EtOAc. Combined organics were dried over MgSO4 and the concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a white solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.50 (t, 1H, J=8.0 Hz), 7.24 (t, 1H, J=6.6 Hz), 3.09 (t, 2H, J=5.5 Hz), 2.72-2.69 (m, 2H).

Step 2: 5,6-difluoro-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine

To a solution of 5,6-difluoro-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-1-one (4.60 g, 27.4 mmol) in MeOH (90 mL) at 40° C. was added isoamyl nitrite (4.17 g, 35.6 mmol) followed by concentrated HCl (2.7 mL). Upon heating for 45 min the solution was cooled to room temperature and water was added. Precipitated solid was collected by filtration and rinsed thoroughly with water affording 3.97 g of a light orange solid. The solid was dissolved in HOAc (100 mL), conc HCl (8 mL) was added, followed by 10% Pd/C (1.07 g). The mixture was hydrogenated under 50 psi H2 for 24 hr using a Parr hydrogenation apparatus, and filtered through a bed of Celite (CHCl3 wash). The filtrate was concentrated in vacuo and the residue was dissolved in water. The aqueous solution was basified with solid K2CO3, extracted with CHCl3 (3×), combined extracts were dried over MgSO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (MeOH/CH2Cl2) affording the title compound as a brown oil. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 6.95 (t, 2H, J=8.9 Hz), 3.83 (m, 1H), 3.10 (dd, 2H, J=15.8 & 6.8 Hz), 2.60 (dd, 2H, J=15.8 & 5.0 Hz); (M+H) 170, 0.68 min (LC/MS method A).

The above oil was dissovled in Et2O (ca. 5 mL) and HCl in dioxane (4 mL of a 4M solution) was added. Precipitated solid was triturated with Et2O and collected by filtration, affording the corresponding hydrochloride salt.

Example III-10 rac 5-fluoro-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine (and Corresponding Hydrochloride Salt)

To a solution of 5-fluoro-1-indanone (10.0 g; 66.7 mmol) in MeOH at 40° C. was added n-butyl nitrite (13.2 mL; 113 mmol), dropwise over 3 minutes, followed by conc HCl (10 mL), dropwise at such a rate that the internal temp was maintained below 55° C. The mixture was stirred 30 min and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was diluted with EtOAc and sat'd NaHCO3, filtered, and the layers were separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc, combined organics were washed (H2O, brine), dried over Na2SO4, and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording an 7.59 g of an orange solid. The solid was dissolved in HOAc/H2SO4 (250/12.5 mL respectively), 10% Pd—C was added (4.5 g; wet, DeGussa type E101) and the mixture was hydrogenated under 50 psi H2 for 18 h using a Parr hydrogenation apparatus. The mixture was filtered through Celite (H2O wash), partially concentrated to an aqueous mixture, and the mixture pH was adjusted to ca. 11 by addition of 1N NaOH. The whole was extracted with CHCl3 (×5), combined organics were washed (brine), dried over Na2SO4, and concentrated in vacuo, affording the title compound as an amber oil. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.69 (br. s, 2H), 2.53 (m, 2H, overlapping solvent), 2.99 (m, 2H), 3.69 (quint, J=6.2 Hz, 1H), 6.89 (partially resolved ddd, J=9.8, −7.7, 2.5 Hz, 1H), 6.99 (partially resolved dd, J=9.3, −2.3 Hz, 1H), 7.16 (partially resolved dd, J=8.3, 5.6 Hz, 1H).

The corresponding hydrochloride salt was obtained as a colorless solid from an analogous preparation of the amine freebase (smaller scale), by addition of ca. 2.5 equivalents HCl in dioxane (4M solution) to the dried chloroform extracts prior to concentration. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) 5 ppm 2.84-3.07 (m, 2H), 3.25 (td, J=17.12, 7.67 Hz, 2H), 3.91-4.09 (m, 1H), 6.94-7.06 (m, 1H), 7.08-7.15 (m, J=9.44, 9.15, 1.05, 1.05 Hz, 1H), 7.28 (dd, J=8.20, 5.35 Hz, 1H), 8.40 (br. s., 3H).

Example III-11 (2S)- and (2R)-5-fluoro-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine hydrochloride

Step 1: rac-(5-fluoro-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl)benzyl carbamate

To a mixture of 5-fluoro-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine (5.79 g; 38.3 mmol; Example III-9 above) and satd Na2CO3 (200 mL) at room temperature was added benzyl chloroformate (6.9 mL; 46 mmol). The mixture was stirred 1 h at room temperature and extracted with EtOAc (×3). Combined organics were washed (H2O, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as an off-white solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 2.77 (m, 2H), 3.12 (m, 2H), 4.29 (app. sext., J=7.1 Hz, 1H), 5.02 (s, 2H), 6.94 (m, 1H), 7.03 (partially resolved dd, J=9.2, ˜2.4 Hz, 1H), 7.19 (partially resolved dd, J=8.2, 5.5 Hz, 1H), 7.28-7.40 (m, 5H), 7.64 (d, J=6.8 Hz, 1H).

Step 2: Resolution of rac-(5-Fluoro-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl)benzyl carbamate into [(2S)-5-fluoro-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl]benzyl carbamate and [(2R)-5-fluoro-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl]benzyl carbamate

rac-(5-Fluoro-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl)benzyl carbamate was separated into individual enantiomers on an AD-H prep column (30 mm ID×25 mm, 5 μm particle size) by supercritical fluid chromatography (MeOH/CO2 17:83, 90 g/min total flow at 140 bar, 33° C.).

Chromatographic bands eluting from the column were detected at 215 nm.

Assignment of absolute configurations for the enantiomers obtained above were made by comparison of experimentally measured vibrational circular dichroism (VCD) spectra with the calculated (ab initio) VCD spectrum for [(2S)-5-fluoro-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl]benzyl carbamate. The earlier-eluting enantiomer from the chiral separation described above was found to have VCD bands of the same relative sign as the (S)-configuration model used for ab initio calculations, and thus assigned the (S)-configuration. In contrast, the latter-eluting enantiomer was found to was found to have VCD bands of the opposite relative sign as the (S)-configuration model used for ab initio calculations, and thus assigned the (R)-configuration.

Step 3: (S)- and (R)-5-fluoro-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine hydrochloride

The preparation of (S)-5-fluoro-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine hydrochloride is given as representative. To a solution of [(2S)-5-fluoro-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl]benzyl carbamate (2.26 g; 7.93 mmol) in EtOAc/EtOH (40 mL ea) was added 10% Pd/C (0.85 g, wet, DeGussa type E101). The mixture was stirred under an atmosphere of H2 for 5 h and filtered through a 0.45 μm PTFE membrane filter. HCl in dioxane (5 mL of a 4M solution) was added to the filtrate and the whole was concentrated to dryness, affording the title compound as a tan solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 2.97 (m, 2H), 3.24 (m, 2H), 4.00 (m, 1), 7.01 (m, 1H), 7.13 (partially resolved dd, J=9.2, ˜2.4 Hz, 1H), 7.28 (dd, J=8.4, 5.4 Hz, 1H), 8.40 (br. s, 2H). (M+H) 152, tR 0.73 min (LC/MS method C). (R)-5-Fluoro-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine hydrochloride was prepared in an analogous fashion; 1H NMR spectrum and LC/MS retention time were identical to those of the (S)-isomer.

Example III-12 rac 2-amino-2,3-dihydro-1H-indene-5-carbonitrile hydrochloride

Step 1: 1,1-Dimethylethyl (5-bromo-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl)carbamate

To a slurry of (5-bromo-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl)amine hydrobromide (5.61 g; 19.1 mmol; prepared according to Prashad, M; Hu, B.; Har, D.; Repic, O.; Blacklock, T.; Acemoglub, M. Adv. Synth. Catal. 2001, 343 (5), 461) in CH2Cl2 (40 mL) was added Et3N (5.8 mL; 42 mmol) in one portion. The mixture was stirred 15 min, (Boc)2O (4.58 g; 21 mmol) was added in one portion and stirring was continued. After 2 h the whole was adsorbed onto a minimal amount of silica gel and purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording 5.94 g of the title compound as a colorless solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 1.39 (s, 9H), 2.73 (m, 2H), 3.08 (m, 2H), 4.20 (app. sext, J=7.0 Hz, 1H), 7.14 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 1H), 7.19 (br. d, J=6.8 Hz, 1H), 7.30 (partially resolved dd, J=8.0, ˜1.9 Hz, 1H), 7.38 (m, 1H) ppm.

Step 2: 1,1-dimethylethyl (5-cyano-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl)carbamate

A flask charged with 1,1-dimethylethyl (5-bromo-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl)carbamate (3.0 g, 9.26 mmol; step 1 above), dppf (645 mg, 1.16 mmol), Pd2dba3 (532 mg, 0.58 mmol), ZnCN2 (1.50 g, 12.8 mmol) and water in 50 mL DMF was evacuated/backfilled with nitrogen (×4), and stirred at 110° C. for 21 hours. Upon cooling, the mixture was diluted with satd NH4Cl and extracted with ethyl acetate. The organic extract was washed with (water 3×, brine), dried over MgSO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residual oil was purified by flash chromatography (ethyl acetate/hexanes) affording title compound as an off-white solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.47 (s, 1H), 7.45 (d, 1H, J=7.9 Hz), 7.28 (d, 1H, J=7.7 Hz), 4.69 (br.s, 1H), 4.47 (br. s, 1H), 3.33-3.25 (m, 2H), 2.86-2.80 (m, 2H), 2.79 (s, 9H).

Step 3: 2-amino-2,3-dihydro-1H-indene-5-carbonitrile hydrochloride

To a solution of 1,1-dimethylethyl (5-cyano-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl)carbamate (1.85 g, 7.18 mmol) in dioxane (30 mL) at room temperature was added HCl in dioxane (18 mL of a 4.0 M solution; 72 mmol). The mixture was stirred for ca. 18 hr and diluted with ether. Solids were collected by filtration and rinsed thoroughly with ether, affording the title compound as a tan solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, methanol-d4) δ ppm 7.65 (s, 1H), 7.59 (d, 1H, J=7.9 Hz), 7.46 (d, 1H, J=7.9 Hz), 4.14 (m, 1H), 3.51-3.43 (m, 2H), 3.10-3.04 (m, 1H).

Example III-13 rac 5-(methyloxy)-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine hydrochloride

Step 1: (2Z)-5-(methyloxy)-1H-indene-1,2(3H)-dione 2-oxime

To a solution of 5-(methyloxy)-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-1-one (1.0 g, 6.2 mmol) in methanol (15 mL) at 40° C. was added n-butyl nitrite (0.8 mL, 6.25 mmol) followed by conc HCl (0.6 mL). The reaction was stirred 30 min, precipitated solid was collected by filtration, air-dried and used without further purification. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 3.60 (br.s, 2H) 3.86 (s, 3H) 6.99 (dd, J=8.54 Hz, 2.2 Hz, 1H) 7.12 (d, J=1.71 Hz, 1H) 7.66 (d, J=8.55 Hz, 1H) 12.45 (s, 1H).

Step 2: 5-(methyloxy)-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine hydrochloride

To a solution of (2Z)-5-(methyloxy)-1H-indene-1,2(3H)-dione 2-oxime (0.96 g, 5.02 mmol) in HOAc/conc H2SO4 (25/2 mL respectively) was added 10% Pd/C (0.200 g, wet) and the mixture was hydrogenated under 50 psi H2 for 7 h at room temperature using a Parr hydrogenation apparatus and filtered over Celite (2×10 mL MeOH wash). The filtrate was partially concentrated and basified ca. pH 12, and the whole was extracted with CH2Cl2 (2×100 mL). Combined organics were dried over Na2SO4, and concentrated to ca. 100 mL. The remaining solution was sparged with anhyd HCl (ca. 1 min), aged 15 min and concentrated to dryness affording the title compound. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 2.84-2.98 (m, 2H), 3.09-3.24 (m, 2H), 3.75 (s, 3H), 3.92 (br. s, 1H), 6.73 (dd, J=8.3, 2.44 Hz, 1H), 6.83 (d, J=2.2 Hz, 1H), 7.13 (d, J=8.1 Hz, 1H), 8.40 (br.s, 2H).

Example III-14 rac 4-(methyloxy)-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine hydrochloride

The title compound was prepared from 4-(methyloxy)-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-1-one according to the method described in example III-13 Steps 1-2 above. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 2.84-2.98 (m, 2H), 3.10-3.27 (m, 2H), 3.75 (s, 3H), 3.95 (br.s, 1H), 6.79 (d, J=8.1 Hz, 1H), 6.84 (d, J=7.3 Hz, 1H), 7.16 (t, J=7.8 Hz, 1H), 8.31 (br.s, 2H).

Example III-15 5,6-bis(methyloxy)-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine hydrochloride

The title compound was prepared from 5,6-bis(methyloxy)-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-1-one according to the method described in example III-13 Steps 1-2 above. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 2.84-2.98 (m, 2H), 3.10-3.27 (m, 2H), 3.75 (s, 3H), 3.95 (br.s, 1H), 6.79 (d, J=8.1 Hz, 1H), 6.84 (d, J=7.3 Hz, 1H), 7.16 (t, J=7.8, Hz, 1H), 8.31 (br.s, 2H).

Example III-16 2-methyl-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine hydrochloride

Step 1: methyl 2-methyl-1-oxo-2,3-dihydro-1H-indene-2-carboxylate

To a solution of diisopropylamine (2.06 mL, 14.6 mmol) in THF (14 mL) at 0° C. was a solution of n-butyl lithium (5.55 mL of a 2.5 M in solution in hexanes; 14.6 mmol), dropwise over 15 min. Meanwhile, a solution of 2-methyl-1-indanone (2.03 g, 13.9 mmol) in THF (10 mL) was prepared and cooled to −78° C. under N2. After 30 minutes the above solution of LDA was cooled to −78° C. and added to the above solution of indanone, dropwise over 15 min via double-ended needle. The mixture was stirred 30 min and methyl cyanoformate (1.32 mL, 16.7 mmol) was added. The mixture was stirred 40 minutes, gradually warming ca. to −20° C., quenched with satd NH4Cl and extracted with Et2O (2×25 mL). Combined organics were washed (brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo, affording the title compound which was used without further purification. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.52 (s, 3H), 3.00 (d, J=17.3 Hz, 1H), 3.67-3.73 (m, 4H), 7.41 (t, J=7.57 Hz, 1H), 7.47 (m, 1H), 7.63 (m, 1H), 7.79 (d, J=7.57 Hz, 1H).

Step 2: methyl 2-methyl-2,3-dihydro-1H-indene-2-carboxylate

A mixture of the methyl 2-methyl-1-oxo-2,3-dihydro-1H-indene-2-carboxylate (2.04 g, 9.99 mmol) and 10% Pd/C (0.200 g; wet) in HOAc/conc H2SO4 (22/2 mL respectively) was hydrogenated under 50 psi H2 for 4 h using a Parr hydrogenation apparatus. The mixture was filtered through Celite (2×MeOH wash) and the filtrate was partially concentrated in vacuo. The residue was neutralized with satd Na2CO3 and the whole was extracted with EtOAc (2×25 mL). Combined organics were washed with brine, dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo affording the title compound. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.35 (s, 3H), 2.81 (d, J=15.6 Hz, 2H), 3.47 (d, J=15.6 Hz, 2H), 3.71 (s, 3H), 7.12-7.23 (m, 4H).

Step 3: 2-Methyl-2,3-dihydro-1H-indene-2-carboxylic acid

To a solution of methyl 2-methyl-2,3-dihydro-1H-indene-2-carboxylate (1.80 g, 9.46 mmol) in THF/water/MeOH (4/1/1 mL respectively) was added lithium hydroxide monohydrate (1.19 g, 28.4 mmol). The reaction mixture stirred at ambient temperature 4 h, acidified to pH 3 with 1 N HCl and extracted with Et2O (2×25 mL). Combined organics were washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo affording the title compound as a white solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.39 (s, 3H), 2.83 (d, J=15.9 Hz, 2H), 3.50 (d, J=15.9 Hz, 2H), 7.12-7.23 (m, 4H).

Step 4: phenylmethyl (2-methyl-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl)carbamate

To a solution of 2-methyl-2,3-dihydro-1H-indene-2-carboxylic acid (0.200 g, 1.14 mmol) and triethylamine (0.17 mL, 1.2 mmol) in benzene (2 mL) at 0° C. was added diphenyl phosphorylazide (0.257 g, 1.19 mmol). The mixture was stirred 15 min, benzyl alcohol (0.123 mL, 1.19 mmol) was added and the reaction was heated under reflux for 16 hours. Upon cooling, the mixture was diluted with 10% HCl and extracted with ethyl acetate (2×25 mL). Combined organics were washed with brine, dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes) affording the title compound. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.55 (s, 3H), 2.98 (d, J=15.9 Hz, 2H), 3.28 (d, J=15.9 Hz, 2H), 7.12-7.18 (m, 4H), 7.29-7.37 (m, 5H).

Step 5: (2-methyl-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl)amine hydrochloride

A mixture phenylmethyl (2-methyl-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl)carbamate (0.271 g; 0.963 mmol), and 10% Pd/C (0.050 g, wet) in EtOH (2 mL) of was hydrogenated under 40 psi H2 for 4 h at using a Parr hydrogenation apparatus and filtered over Celite. The filtrate was concentrated to an oil, dissolved in ethyl acetate, cooled to −70° C. and sparged with anhyd HCl until saturated. The mixture was stirred for 1 hour and concentrated to dryness affording the title compound as a white solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, methanol-d4) δ ppm 1.56 (s, 3H), 3.17 (br.s, 4H), 7.19-7.29 (m, 4H).

Compounds of Formula IV

Example IV-1 3-bromo-4-methylbenzamide

To a slurry of 3-bromo-4-methylbenzoic acid (2.53 g, 85% purity; 10 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (20 mL) at 0° C., under N2, was added oxalyl chloride (0.91 mL; 10.5 mmol), followed by dropwise addition of DMF (0.04 mL; 0.5 mmol). The mixture was stirred 5 min at 0° C., 15 min at rt, and then heated at reflux under N2 for 1 h. The mixture was cooled, and poured into NH4OH (30 mL; ca. 30% NH3). Precipitated solids were collected by filtration and purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a colorless solid. LC/MS (method A) tR 2.05 min; m/z 214, 216 (M+H, Br isotopes).

The following were prepared by a procedure similar to Example IV-1, from the appropriate carboxylic acids.

TABLE B Synthesis of Compounds of Formula IV from benzoic acids Characterization Ex Structure/Name Data Comments IV-2 LC/MS (method A) tR 1.87 min; m/z 223, 225 (M + H, Br isotopes) Note 1 IV-3 LC/MS (method B) tR 1.80 min; m/z 214, 216 (M + H, Br isotopes) Note 1, 3 IV-4 LC/MS (method A) tR 2.06 min; m/z 214 ([M + H]+) Note 1, 2 IV-5 LC/MS (method A) tR 1.88 min; m/z 218 ([M + H]+) Note 1, 2 IV-6 LC/MS (method B) tR 1.79 min; m/z 200, 202 (M + H, Br isotopes) Note 1, 4 IV-7 LC/MS (method A) tR 1.72 min; m/z 218 (M + H). Note 1, 2 Note 1 Chromatographic purification step omitted. Note 2 Preparation of acid chloride using 4 equivalents of oxalyl chloride at room temperature for 3 hours. Note 3 5-Bromo-2-methylbenzoic acid may be obtained commercially from various sources (e.g., Ryan Scientific, Inc., Mt. Pleasant, SC, USA). Note 4 Acid activation with oxalyl chloride/DMF was omitted; commercially available 3-bromobenzoyl chloride was used (Sigma-Aldrich, St. Louis, MO, USA).

Example IV-8 3-Bromo-5-chlorobenzamide

To a solution of 3-bromo-5-chlorobenzoic acid (2.88 g; 12.2 mmol; Note 1) and pyridine (1.04 mL; 12.8 mmol) in MeCN (100 mL) at room temperature was added (Boc)2O (3.47 g; 15.9 mmol) in one portion. The mixture was aged 30 min, (NH4)2CO3 was added in one portion.

After stirring approximately 16 h at room temperature, volatiles were removed in vacuo. The residue was partitioned between EtOAc/water and the layers were separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc (×2), combined organics were washed (10% HCl, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a colorless solid. LC/MS (method A) tR 1.65 min; m/z 234, 236 (M+H, Br isotopes).

Note 1: 3-bromo-5-chlorobenzoic acid was obtained commercially from Biofine International Inc., Blaine, Wash., USA.

The following were prepared by a procedure similar to Example IV-8 from the appropriate carboxylic acids.

TABLE C Compounds of Formula IV from benzoic acids and (NH4)2CO3 Ex Structure/Name Characterization Data Comments IV-9 LC/MS (method A) tR 2.12 min; m/z 214, 216 (M + H, Br isotopes) Note 1 Carboxylic acid from SALOR (Aldrich) IV-10 LC/MS (method B) tR 2.38 min; m/z 268, 270 (M + H, Br isotopes) [M − H] Note 2 Carboxylic acid from Matrix Scientific, Columbia, SC, USA IV-11 LC/MS (method B) tR 1.43 min; m/z 201, 203 (M + H, Br isotopes) Note 2 IV-12 LC/MS (method B) tR 1.36 min; m/z 157 Note 2 IV-13 LC/MS (method A) tR 1.65 min; m/z 234, 236 (M + H, Br isotopes) Note 3 Note 1 Pyridine was added to solution of carboxylic acid and (Boc)2O. Note 2 Chromatographic purification step omitted. Note 3 3-Bromo-2-chlorobenzoic acid may be obtained from the commercially available 3-bromo-2-chlorotoluene according to the procedure of Liedholm, B. Acta Chem. Scand. B Org. Chem. Biochem. 1984, B38(8), 713.

Example IV-14 3-bromo-2-methoxybenzamide

Step 1: 3-bromo-2-hydroxybenzonitrile

To a solution of o-cyanophenol (0.595 g; 5.00 mmol) and diisopropylamine (0.060 mL; 0.40 mmol) in PhMe (50 mL) at 70° C. was added NBS (0.980 g; 5.50 mmol) in one portion. The mixture was stirred 2 h, an additional portion of NBS (0.089 g; 0.5 mmol) was added and heating continued until disappearance of starting material was observed (TLC). The mixture was cooled, diluted with EtOAc washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. Attempted resolution of the two reaction products by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), was unsuccessful; thus the mixture of products was dissolved in DMF (10 mL), K2CO3 (2.07 g; 15.0 mmol) and MeI (0.47 mL; 7.5 mmol) were added and the mixture was stirred overnight at room temperature. The mixture was poured into water and extracted with Et2O (×3). Combined organics were washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a colorless solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 3.97 (s, 3H), 7.26 (app. t, J=7.9 Hz, 1H), 7.86 (dd, J=7.8, 1.5 Hz, 1H), 8.01 (dd, J=8.1, 1.5 Hz, 1H). The product obtained above was combined with that of a similar reaction wherein N-methylbenzylamine (0.08 equiv) was substituted for the above diisopropylamine catalyst.

Step 2: 3-bromo-2-methoxybenzamide

To a slurry of 3-bromo-2-methoxybenzamide (0.933 g; 4.40 mmol) and K2CO3 (0.304 g; 2.2 mmol) in DMSO (10 mL) at 0° C. was added H2O2 (0.5 mL of a 30 wt % solution; ˜4.8 mmol), dropwise over 2 min. The cooling bath was removed, the mixture was stirred at room temperature 3 days, poured into water and precipitated solid was collected by filtration. The filtrate was extracted 3×EtOAc, combined organics were washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was combined with the above precipitated solid and the whole was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a colorless solid. LC/MS (method A) tR 1.88 min; m/z 230, 232 (M+H, Br isotopes).

The following were prepared from the appropriate benzonitriles by a procedure similar to Example IV-14, Step 2.

TABLE D Compounds of Formula IV via the corresponding benzonitrile Ex Structure/Name Characterization Data Comments IV-15   2-(3-bromophenyl) acetamide LC/MS (method A) tR 1.78 min; m/z 214, 216 (M + H, Br isotopes) Chromato- graphic purification step omitted IV-16   3-bromo-2- fluorobenzamide LC/MS (method B) tR 1.73 min; m/z 218, 220 (M + H, Br isotopes) Nitrile from Oakwood Products, Inc. West Columbia, SC, USA. IV-17   3-bromo-5- fluorobenzamide 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 7.68 (br. s, 1H), 7.69 (ddd, J = 9.6, 1.2 Hz, 2 H, overlapping 7.68), 7.75 (ddd, J = 8.2, 2.5, 1.6 Hz, 1 H), 7.92 (partially resolved dd, J = 1.4 Hz, 1 H), 8.16 (br. s., 1 H) Nitrile from Matrix Scientific, Columbia, SC, USA.

Example IV-18 2-Bromo-1,3-thiazole-4-carboxamide

Step 1: 2-Bromo-1,3-thiazole-4-carboxylic Acid

A mixture of methyl 2-bromo-1,3-thiazole-4-carboxylate (4.2 g, 18.9 mmol), THF (120 mL) and 1N lithium hydroxide (50 mL) was heated at 70° C. for 1 h. The organic solvent was removed in vacuo. The residual aqueous solution was cooled to 0-5° C. and acidified to pH1 with 1N HCl solution. The tile compound was obtained by filtration, as a white solid.

1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 8.43 (s, 1H) 13.30 (s, 1H).

Step 2: 2-Bromo-1,3-thiazole-4-carboxamide

To a suspension of 2-bromo-1,3-thiazole-4-carboxylic acid (3.82 g, 18.4 mmol) and a catalytic amount of DMF in CH2Cl2 (100 mL) at 0° C. was slowly added thionyl chloride (14 mL of a 2M solution in CH2Cl2). The resulting mixture was stirred for 12 h at the room temperature and then heated to reflux for 1 h. The mixture was concentrated to dryness in vacuo. The white solid obtained was taken up in ethyl acetate, added to a pre-cooled (0° C.) 9-10% aqueous ammonium hydroxide solution (90 ml) and stirred for 1 h at 0° C. The organic layer was separated and the aqueous phase was extracted twice with ethyl acetate. The combined ethyl acetate solution was washed with brine, dried over magnesium sulfate and concentrated in vacuo, affording the title compound was obtained as an off-white solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 7.60 (s, 1H), 7.82 (s, 1H), 8.22 (s, 1H).

Example IV-1 4-iodo-3-(methyloxy)benzamide

Step 1: methyl 4-iodo-3-(methyloxy)benzoate

To a solution of 3-hydroxy-4-iodobenzoic acid (3.0 g, 0.011 mol) in acetone (50 mL) was added in one portion potassium carbonate (3.9 g, 0.028 mol). Dimethyl sulfate (3.5 g, 0.028 mol) was added dropwise and the mixture was heated at reflux overnight. The mixture was concentrated in vacuo and the residue was partitioned between ethyl acetate and aqueous saturated sodium bicarbonate solution. The organic phase was washed with brine, dried over sodium sulfated and concentrated in vacuo to give methyl 4-iodo-3-(methyloxy)benzoate as a yellow oil. 1H NMR (DMSO-d6) δ ppm 3.83 (s, 3H, Me), 3.87 (s, 3H, Me), 7.30 (dd, J=8.0, 1.8 Hz, 1H, Ar), 7.40 (d, J=1.7 Hz, 1H, Ar), 7.92 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 1H, Ar).

Step 2: 4-iodo-3-(methyloxy)benzoic acid

A mixture of methyl 4-iodo-3-(methyloxy)benzoate (3.25 g, 0.011 mol), sodium hydroxide (0.48 g, 0.012 mol) and water (30 mL) in methanol (30 mL) was heated in an oil bath at 65° C. for 3 hr. The mixture was concentrated in vacuo to remove the methanol and the aqueous residue was chilled in an ice bath. Concentrated aqueous hydrogen chloride was added until the pH was acidic and the mixture was stirred at ice bath temperature. The resulting solid was filtered, washed with water and dried to give 4-iodo-3-(methyloxy)benzoic acid as a white solid, used without further purification. LC/MS (method A) tR 2.35 min; m/z 279 (M+H).

Step 3: 4-iodo-3-(methyloxy)benzamide

Oxalyl chloride (5.1 g, 0.04 mol) was added dropwise to a mixture of 4-iodo-3-(methyloxy)benzoic acid (2.9 g, 0.01 mol) and DMF (3 drops) in dichloromethane (60 mL) at room temperature. After 3 hr, the mixture was concentrated in vacuo. The residue was dissolved in dichloromethane (30 mL) and this solution was added dropwise to concentrated ammonium hydroxide (40 mL) at ice bath temperature. The mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight. The mixture was partially concentrated in vacuo and the aqueous residue was extracted with ethyl acetate. The organic extract was washed (satd Na2CO3, brine), dried with sodium sulfate and concentrated in vacuo to give 4-iodo-3-(methyloxy)benzamide as a white solid, used without further purification. LC/MS (method A) tR 1.95 min; m/z 278 (M+H).

Example IV-20 4-(aminocarbonyl)-2-chlorophenyl trifluoromethane sulfonate

Step 1: 4-(aminocarbonyl)-2-chlorophenyl 1,1-dimethylethyl carbonate

To a solution of 3-chloro-4-hydroxybenzoic acid (4.0 g, 0.022 mol) and pyridine (0.8 mL) in acetonitrile (50 mL) was added di-tert-butyl dicarbonate (9.6 g, 0.044 mol) in one portion followed by ammonium bicarbonate (3.5 g, 0.044 mol) in one portion and the mixture was stirred at ambient temperature for 18 hr. The reaction mixture was concentrated in vacuo and the residue was partitioned between ethyl acetate and water. The ethyl acetate phase was washed with 5% aqueous sodium bicarbonate, 0.1N HCl and brine. The organic phase was dried over sodium sulfate, filtered and concentrated in vacuo to give 4-(aminocarbonyl)-2-chlorophenyl 1,1-dimethylethyl carbonate as a viscous yellow oil, used without further purification. LC/MS (method A) tR 2.25 min; m/z (M+H) 272.

Step 2: 3-chloro-4-hydroxybenzamide

A mixture of 4-(aminocarbonyl)-2-chlorophenyl 1,1-dimethylethyl carbonate (6.86 g, 0.025 mol) and 4N HCl in dioxane (50 mL) in dioxane (30 mL) was heated at reflux for 4 hr. The reaction mixture was cooled, and precipitated solid was collected by filtration affording 3-chloro-4-hydroxybenzamide as a white solid, used without further purification. LC/MS (method E) tR 0.88 min; m/z 172 (M+H).

Step 3: 4-(aminocarbonyl)-2-chlorophenyl trifluoromethane sulfonate

To a mixture of 3-chloro-4-hydroxybenzamide (3.3 g, 0.019 mol) and pyridine (3.0 g, 0.038 mol) in dichloromethane (30 mL) at ice bath temperature was added dropwise trifluoromethanesulfonic anhydride (5.9 g, 0.021 mol). The mixture was allowed to come to ambient temperature overnight. The reaction mixture was washed (water, brine), dried by passing through a plug of sodium sulfate and concentrated in vacuo affording 4-(aminocarbonyl)-2-chlorophenyl trifluoromethane sulfonate as a pale yellow solid, used without further purification. LC/MS (method B) tR 2.48 min; m/z 304 (M+H).

Compounds of Formula IV (Heterocycles) Example IV-21 2-(3-Bromophenyl)-1H-imidazole

Step 1: Methyl 3-bromobenzenecarboximidoate hydrochloride

A solution of m-bromobenzonitrile (1.82 g; 10 mmol) in MeOH (20 mL) at 0° C. was sparged with HCl gas for 30 min, the reaction flask was stoppered and aged in a refrigerator (ca. 5° C.) for 3 h. The mixture was sparged with N2 to remove excess HCl, concentrated in vacuo (2×PhMe chase) and dried under high vacuum ca. 45 min, affording the title compound as a colorless solid which was used directly for Step 2 below. LC/MS (method A) tR 0.81 min, m/z 214, 216 (M+H, Br isotopes).

Step 2: N-[2,2-bis(ethyloxy)ethyl]-3-bromobenzene carboximidamide

To a solution of methyl 3-bromobenzenecarboximidoate hydrochloride (Step 1 above) in MeOH (10 mL) at 0° C. was added [2,2-bis(ethyloxy)ethyl]amine (1.74 mL; 12 mmol) in one portion and the mixture was gradually warmed to room temperature (overnight). The mixture was concentrated in vacuo, partitioned between CH2Cl2/1M NaOH and the layers were separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with CH2Cl2 (×2), combined organics were washed (H2O, brine), dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated in vacuo affording the title compound as a light brown oil which was used directly for Step 3 below. LC/MS (method A) tR 1.25 min, m/z 315, 317 (M+H, Br isotopes, 4%), 223, 225 (M+H−2EtOH, Br isotopes, 100%).

Step 3: 2-(3-Bromophenyl)-1H-imidazole

A solution of N-[2,2-bis(ethyloxy)ethyl]-3-bromobenzenecarboximidamide (2.85 g; 9.04 mmol; Step 2 above) in HCO2H (15 mL) was heated at 80° C. for 1 h and concentrated in vacuo (2×PhMe chase). The residue was purified by flash chromatography (MeOH/NH4OH/CH2Cl2), affording the title compound as a light pink solid. LC/MS (method A) tR 1.19 min, m/z 223, 225 (M+H, Br isotopes).

Example IV-22 2-(4-bromophenyl)-1H-imidazole

The title compound was prepared from p-bromobenzonitrile as described for the preparation Example IV-21, with the exception that purification of the title compound consisted of a combination of recrystallization (i-PrOH) and flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes). LC/MS (method A) tR 1.25 min, m/z 223, 225 (M+H, Br isotopes).

Example IV-23 3-(3-Bromophenyl)-1-({[2-(trimethylsilyl)ethyl]oxy}methyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazole and 5-(3-bromophenyl)-1-({[2-(trimethylsilyl)ethyl]oxy}methyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazole

Step 1: 3-(3-Bromophenyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazole

To a slurry of methyl 3-bromobenzenecarboximidoate hydrochloride (example IV-21 Step 1; 0.541 g; 2.18 mmol) in pyridine (3 mL) at 0° C. was added a solution of formic hydrazide (0.157 g; 2.62 mmol). The flask was stoppered and gradually warmed to room temperature (overnight) and poured into water (˜20 mL). Precipitated solid was collected by filtration and the filtrate was extracted with EtOAc (×3). Combined extracts were washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4, concentrated in vacuo. The residue obtained was combined with the above precipitate, and the whole was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a colorless solid. LC/MS (method A) tR 2.49 min, m/z 224, 226 (M+H, Br isotopes).

Step 2: 3-(3-Bromophenyl)-1-({[2-(trimethylsilyl)ethyl]oxy}methyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazole and 5 (3-bromophenyl)-1-({[2-(trimethylsilyl)ethyl]oxy}methyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazole

To a slurry of hexanes-washed NaH (0.085 g of a 60 wt % suspension in mineral oil; ˜2.1 mmol) in DMF (3 mL) at 0° C. was added a solution of 3-(3-bromophenyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazole (0.238 g; 1.06 mmol; Step 1 above) in DMF (1 mL), dropwise over 2 min. The mixture was stirred 30 min and SEM-Cl (0.22 mL; 1.27 mmol) was added, dropwise. The mixture was gradually warmed to room temperature (overnight), poured into water and extracted with EtOAc (×3). Combined organics were washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording two regioisomeric N-protected triazoles. The earlier-eluting regioisomer was a colorless gum; the later-eluting regioisomer was a colorless, waxy solid (ratio ˜2:5 earlier:later). Earlier-eluting isomer 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 0.02 (s, 9H), 0.95-1.05 (m, 2H), 3.77-3.86 (m, 2H), 5.51 (s, 2H), 7.39 (t, J=7.94 Hz, 1H), 7.65 (ddd, J=8.07, 2.01, 0.98 Hz, 1H), 7.89 (ddd, J=7.71, 1.65, 0.98 Hz, 1H), 7.97 (s, 1H), 8.12 (app. t, J=1.87 Hz, 1H). Later-eluting isomer 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) d ppm 0.01 (s, 9H), 0.93-1.00 (m, 2H), 3.66-3.73 (m, 2H), 5.53 (s, 2H), 7.33 (t, J=7.94 Hz, 1H), 7.54 (ddd, J=7.94, 2.05, 1.07 Hz, 1H), 8.06 (ddd, J=7.76, 1.52, 1.07 Hz, 1H), 8.27 (s, 1H), 8.31 (app. t, J=1.78 Hz, 1H).

Example IV-24 [3-(3-Bromophenyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazol-1-yl]methyl 2,2-dimethylpropanoate

Step 1: 3-(3-Bromophenyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazole (Alternate Preparation)

A slurry of 3-bromobenzamide (77.4 g; 387 mmol) in DMF-DMA (150 mL) was prepared at room temperature and heated to 80° C. for 5 h. The mixture was cooled, poured into ice water (˜2 L) and stirred at room temperature 2 h. Precipitated solid was collected by filtration and washed with water (3×500 mL) and hexanes (2×200 mL), and the cake was air-dried on the filter. The above solid was added to a solution of hydrazine monohydrate (18.0 mL; 370 mmol) in acetic acid (500 mL) at room temperature (internal temp RT→˜40° C. during addition). The mixture was stirred 5 min and heated to 90° C. for 90 min. The mixture was cooled, and partially concentrated in vacuo to approximately 100 mL. The mixture was poured into ice water (˜3 L) and stirred 1 h. Precipitated solid was collected by filtration, washed with water and the cake was air-dried on the filter overnight. The solid was recrystallized from benzene, affording the title compound as a colorless solid. LC/MS (method E) tR 0.61 min, m/z 224, 226 (M+H Br isotopes).

Step 2: [3-(3-Bromophenyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazol-1-yl]methyl 2,2-dimethylpropanoate

A slurry of 3-(3-bromophenyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazole (58.5 g; 261 mmol; Step 1 above), anhydrous K2CO3 (43.2 g; 313 mmol), and chloromethylpivalate (45 mL; 313 mmol) in dry MeCN (250 mL) was heated to 80° C. (Note 1) for 1 hour. The mixture was cooled, solid was collected by filtration and the filtrate was concentrated in vacuo Residue from the filtaret was combined with the filtered solid and the whole was stirred with water approximately 20 minutes. Solid was collected by filtration, washed with water (×3) and recrystallized from MeOH/water, affording the title compound as a colorless solid. LC/MS (method E) tR 0.88 min, m/z 338, 340 (M+H, Br isotopes).

The following were prepared from the appropriate benzamides by a procedure similar to Example IV-25.

TABLE E Compounds of Formula IV from the corresponding benzamide Ex Structure/Name Characterization Data Comments IV-26   [3-(3-bromo-2-fluorophenyl)-1H-1,2,4- triazol-1-yl]methyl 2,2- dimethylpropanoate LC/MS (method B) tR 2.75 min, m/z 356 (79Br), 358 (Br isotopes) Note 1, 2, 3 DMF used as solvent for Step 2. Used IV-16 benzamide IV-27   [3-(3-bromo-2-methylphenyl)-1H- 1,2,4-triazol-1-yl] methyl 2,2- dimethylpropanoate LC/MS (method A) tR 2.85 min, m/z 352 (79Br), 354 (Br isotopes) Note 1, 2, 3 Used IV-2 benzamide IV-28   [3-(3-bromo-2-chlorophenyl)-1H-1,2,4- triazol-1-yl]methyl 2,2- dimethylpropanoate LC/MS (method A) tR 2.72 min, m/z 372 (79Br), 374 (Br isotopes) Note 1, 2, 3 Used IV-13 benzamide IV-29   [3-(3-bromophenyl)-1H-pyrazol-1- yl]methyl 2,2-dimethylpropanoate LC/MS (method A) tR 2.89 min, m/z 235 (79Br), 237 (Br isotopes) Note 4 IV-30   [3-(4-bromophenyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazol-1- yl]methyl 2,2-dimethylpropanoate 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.09- 1.28 (s, 9 H), 6.06 (s, 2 H), 7.57 (d, J = 8.55 Hz, 2 H), 7.98 (d, J = 8.55 Hz, 2 H), 8.35 (s, 1 H) Note 1, 2 IV-31   [3-(4-bromo-3-methylphenyl)-1H-1,2,4- triazol-1-yl]methyl 2,2- dimethylpropanoate 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.18 (s, 9 H), 2.45 (s, 3 H), 6.06 (s, 2 H), 7.59 (d, J = 8.30 Hz, 1 H), 7.78 (dd, J = 8.06, 1.71 Hz, 1 H), 7.99 (s, 1 H), 8.34 (s, 1 H) Note 1, 2 Used IV-4 benzamide IV-32   [3-(4-bromo-3-fluorophenyl)-1H-1,2,4- triazol-1-yl]methyl 2,2- dimethylpropanoate (M + H) 356, (Br isotopes) 358, tR 0.91 min LC/MS (method B, gradient time = 1.5 min) Note 1, 2, 3 Used IV-5 benzamide Note 1 In some cases, benzamide adducts with DMF—DMA (step 1) were more conveniently isolated by solvent extraction after pouring the reaction mixture into water rather than recrystalliztion. Note 2 N—H triazole product of step 1 was used directly for Step 2 without recrystallization. Note 3 N-alkylated triazole product of Step 2 was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes) Note 4 Step 2 only (N-alkylation); Cs2CO3 was substituted for K2CO3. 5-(3-bromophenyl)-1H-pyrazole may be obtained from commercial sources (e.g., Sigma-Aldrich, St. Louis, MO, USA).

Example IV-33 [4-(3-bromophenyl)-1H-1,2,3-triazol-1-yl]methyl 2,2-dimethylpropanoate

To a mixture of 1-bromo-3-ethynylbenzene (0.430 g; 2.38 mmol; Note 1), and azidomethyl 2,2-dimethylpropanoate (0.391 g; 2.49 mmol; Note 2) in t-BuOH/water (3.5/3.0 mL respectively) at room temperature was added a solution of CuSO4.5H2O in water (0.030 g/0.5 mL), followed by sodium ascorbate (0.141 g; 0.71 mmol) in one portion. The mixture was stirred 25 h at room temperature, diluted with water and extracted with EtOAc (×3). Combined organics were washed (5% NH4OH, water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo affording the title compound as a tan solid which was used without further purification. LC/MS (method B) 2.77 min, m/z 338, 340 (M+H, Br isotopes).

  • Note 1 1-Bromo-3-ethynylbenzene may be obtained according to the procedure of Wettergren, J; Minidis, A. Tetrahedron. Lett. 2003, 44(41), 7611.
  • Note 2 Azidomethyl 2,2-dimethylpropanoate may be obtained according to the procedure of Loren, J; Krasiński, A.; Fokin, V.; Sharpless, K. B. Synlett 2005, 18, 2847.

Example IV-34 3-(3-bromophenyl)-5-isoxazolamine

To a solution of 3-(3-bromophenyl)-3-oxopropanenitrile (1.12 g; 5.00 mmol; Note 1) in EtOH (20 mL) was added a solution of hydroxylamine hydrochloride (1.74 g; 25 mmol) and NaOAc (2.46 g; 30 mmol) in water (20 mL). The mixture was heated under reflux for 1 h, cooled and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was slurried in 1N NaOH and extracted with Et2O (×1). The organic layer was washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo affording the title compound as a pale yellow solid which was used without further purification. LC/MS (method B) 2.21 min, m/z 239, 241 (Br isotopes).

Example IV-35 1-(3-bromophenyl)-1,3-dihydro-2H-imidazol-2-one

A solution of 1-bromo-3-isocyanatobenzene (1.0 mL, 8.01 mmol) and [2,2-bis(methyloxy)ethyl]amine (0.86 mL, 8.01 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (15 mL) was stirred at room temperature for 16 hr. The solution was concentrated in vacuo and the residue taken up in a mixture of CH3CN (10 mL) and H2O (3 mL). TFA (3 mL) was added and the solution stirred at room temperature for 4 hr. The solution was concentrated in vacuo, the residue taken up in EtOAc then washed with satd NaHCO3, H2O, and brine. The organics were then dried over Na2SO4, concentrated in vacuo and the residue recrystallized from EtOAc to give 1-(3-bromophenyl)-1,3-dihydro-2H-imidazol-2-one as a white solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 6.60 (d, J=3.0 Hz, 1H), 7.03 (d, J=3.0 Hz, 1H), 7.34-7.36 (m, 2H); 7.70-7.72 (m, 1H), 8.06 (s, 1H), 10.39 (br s, 1H).

Intermediate IV-36 4-(3-bromophenyl)-2-(triphenylmethyl)-2,4-dihydro-3H-1,2,4-triazol-3-one

Step 1: 4-(3-bromophenyl)-2,4-dihydro-3H-1,2,4-triazol-3-one

A mixture of 3-bromoaniline (1.0 mL, 9.18 mmol), methyl hydrazinocarboxylate (788 mg, 8.75 mmol), triethyl orthoformate (0.96 mL, 8.75 mmol), and TsOH (25 mg) in MeOH (20 mL) was stirred at 65° C. for 3 hr. After cooling to room temperature, NaOMe (1.47 g, 26.2 mmol) was added and the mixture stirred at room temperature for 16 hr. After concentration in vacuo the residue was taken up in EtOAc and H2O then acidified with 1N HCl. The aqueous phase was extracted with EtOAc and the combined organics washed with H2O then extracted twice with 1N NaOH. Combined NaOH extracts were acidified with conc. HCl and aged 5 min. Resulting solids were collected by filtration, washed with H2O and dried to give 4-(3-bromophenyl)-2,4-dihydro-3H-1,2,4-triazol-3-one as a white solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 7.42-7.46 (m, 1H), 7.53 (d, J=7.8 Hz, 1H), 7.72 (d, J=7.8 Hz, 1H), 7.98 (s, 1H), 8.43 (s, 1H), 12.03 (s, 1H).

Step 2: 4-(3-bromophenyl)-2-(triphenylmethyl)-2,4-dihydro-3H-1,2,4-triazol-3-one

A mixture of 4-(3-bromophenyl)-2,4-dihydro-3H-1,2,4-triazol-3-one (250 mg, 1.04 mmol) and NaH (50 mg of a 60% dispersion in mineral oil, 1.25 mmol) in DMF (3 mL) was stirred at room temperature for 30 min. To the solution was added 1,1′,1″-(chloromethanetriyl)tribenzene (305 mg, 1.09 mmol) and the mixture stirred at room temperature for 4 hr. The reaction mixture was diluted with EtOAc, washed with H2O and brine, dried over Na2SO4 then concentrated in vacu. The residue was purified by silica gel chromatography (EtOAc/Hexanes) to give 4-(3-bromophenyl)-2-(triphenylmethyl)-2,4-dihydro-3H-1,2,4-triazol-3-one as a pale yellow foam. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 7.22-7.31 (m, 15H), 7.40-7.42 (m, 1H), 7.51 (d, J=7.8 Hz, 1H), 7.63 (d, J=7.8 Hz, 1H), 7.90 (s, 1H), 8.60 (s, 1H).

Intermediate IV-37 1-(3-bromophenyl)-3-(triphenylmethyl)-2,4-imidazolidinedione

Step 1: 1-(3-bromophenyl)-2,4-imidazolidinedione

A solution of 3-bromoaniline (1.0 mL, 9.18 mmol) and chloroacetyl isocyanate (0.780 mL, 9.18 mmol) in dioxane (100 mL) was stirred at room temperature for 2 hr. Dioxane (50 mL) and DBU (3.40 mL, 23.0 mmol) were added and the solution stirred at room temperature for 16 hr. The solution was concentrated in vacuo and the residue taken up in EtOAc and H2O. The mixture was then acidified with 1N HCl, then the aqueous phase extracted with EtOAc. The combined organics were then washed with H2O and brine and dried over Na2SO4. The solution was concentrated in vacuo and the residue recrystallized from EtOAc/hexanes to give 1-(3-bromophenyl)-2,4-imidazolidinedione as a tan solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 4.42 (s, 2H), 7.24-7.30 (m, 2H), 7.50-7.52 (m, 1H), 7.87 (s, 1H), 11.27 (s, 1H).

Step 2: 1-(3-bromophenyl)-3-(triphenylmethyl)-2,4-imidazolidinedione

The trityl protection to render the title compound was performed in a manner similar to that described in the preparation of IV-36 Step 2. 1H NMR (CDCl3) δ ppm 4.20 (s, 2H), 7.17-7.22 (m, 4H), 7.25-7.28 (m, 8H), 7.46-7.48 (m 6H), 7.79 (s, 1H).

Intermediate IV-38 1-(3-bromophenyl)-2-imidazolidinone

1-Chloro-2-isocyanatoethane (1.18 mL, 13.8 mmol) was added dropwise to a solution of 3-bromoaniline (1.5 mL, 13.8 mmol) in DMF (30 mL) at 0° C. then stirred at room temperature for 16 hr, then 70° C. for 2 hr. The solution was cooled to room temperature and 1-chloro-2-isocyanatoethane (0.40 mL, 4.69 mmol) was added. After stirring at room temperature for 2 hr, the solution was diluted with DMF (120 mL), cooled to 0° C. and NaH (660 mg, 60% dispersion in mineral oil, 16.5 mmol) added in portions. The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 64 hr, then diluted with EtOAc. After washing with H2O three times then brine the solution was dried over Na2SO4, concentrated in vacuo and the residue purified by silica gel chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes) to give 1-(3-bromophenyl)-2-imidazolidinone as a white solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 3.56-3.62 (m, 2H), 3.88-3.92 (m, 2H), 5.20 (br s, 1H), 7.15-7.20 (m, 2H), 7.49-7.51 (m, 1H), 7.71 (s, 1H).

Intermediate IV-39 2-(3-bromophenyl)-1,2,5-thiadiazolidine 1,1-dioxide

A solution of SO2Cl2 (12.6 mL, 0.155 mol) and 2-chloroethylamine hydrochloride (3.0 g, 25.9 mmol) in CH3CN (100 mL) was stirred at 75° C. for 16 hr. The solution was concentrated and the residue dried in vacuo. The residue was then extracted with two 15 mL portions of Et2O and the combined washes then added dropwise to a solution of 3-bromoaniline (1.70 mL, 15.5 mmol) and TEA (7.20 mL, 51.7 mmol) in Et2O (15 mL) at −78° C. After stirring at room temperature for 16 hr, the mixture was diluted with EtOAc then washed with H2O and brine, dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated. To the residue was added DMSO (100 mL) and K2CO3 (3.60 g, 26.0 mmol). After stirring at room temperature for 2 hr the mixture was poured into H2O (500 mL), extracted twice with EtOAc and the combined organics washed with H2O and brine then concentrated. The residue was recrystallized from EtOAc/hexanes to give 2-(3-bromophenyl)-1,2,5-thiadiazolidine 1,1-dioxide as a light brown solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 3.48-3.49 (m, 2H), 3.82-3.85 (m, 2H), 7.15 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 7.23 (d, J=8.0 Hz, 1H), 7.29-7.33 (m, 2H), 7.85 (br s, 1H).

Intermediate IV-40 2-(3-bromophenyl)isothiazolidine 1,1-dioxide

To a solution of 3-bromoaniline (1.0 mL, 9.18 mmol) and TEA (2.60 mL, 18.5 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (20 mL) was added 3-chloro-1-propanesulfonyl chloride (1.40 mL, 11.5 mmol) at 0° C. After stirring at room temperature for 16 hr, 3-chloro-1-propanesulfonyl chloride (1.40 mL, 11.5 mmol) and TEA (2.6 mL, 18.5 mmol) was added and the solution stirred at room temperature for 2 hr.

The solution was then washed with HCl (1.0 N, aq) and brine, dried over Na2SO4 then concentrated in vacuo. The residue was then taken up in DMF (40 mL) and DBU (4.10 mL, 27.6 mmol) was added. The mixture was stirred at room temperature for 64 hr, diluted with EtOAc, then washed with 1N HCl and brine then concentrated. The residue was purified by silica gel chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes) to give 2-(3-bromophenyl)isothiazolidine 1,1-dioxide as an off-white solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 2.50-2.54 (m, 2H), 3.37 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 2H), 3.74 (t, J=7.5 Hz, 2H), 7.22-7.24 (m, 3H), 7.33 (s, 1H).

Compounds of Formula V

Example V-1 (5-bromo-2-thienyl)methyl][2-(3-fluorophenyl)ethyl]amine

To a 100 mL round bottom flask was added 5-bromo-2-thiophenecarbaldehyde (0.24 mL, 2 mmol), [2-(3-fluorophenyl)ethyl]amine (0.29 mL, 2.2 mmol), HOAc (0.12 mL, 1 mmol), sodium triacetoxyborohydride (1.2 g, 6 mmol) and 1,2-dichloroethane (10 mL). The reaction was stirred overnight at room temperature, quenched with H2O, and extracted with CH2Cl2 three times. The mixture was washed with brine, dried with MgSO4 and concentrated under reduced pressure. The crude material was purified by silica gel column chromatography (ethyl acetate/hexane) affording the title compound. LC/MS (method A) tR 1.54 min; m/z 315 (M+H).

The following examples were prepared from the appropriate heteroaromatic aldehydes and amines using a procedure similar to Example V-3.

TABLE F Compounds of Formula V from the corresponding heteroaromatic aldehyde Ex Structure/Name Characterization Data Comments V-2   [(5-bromo-2-thienyl)methyl][2-(2- thienyl)ethyl]amine LC/MS (method A) tR 1.37 min; m/z 302, 304 (M + H, Br isotopes) V-3   [(5-bromo-2-thienyl)methyl](3- methylbutyl)amine LC/MS (method A) tR 1.35 min; m/z 262, 264 (M + H, Br isotopes) V-4   [(4-bromo-2-thienyl)methyl](3- methylbutyl)amine LC/MS (method A) tR 1.26 min; m/z 262, 264 (M + H, Br isotopes) V-5   [(4-bromo-2-thienyl)methyl][2-(2- thienyl)ethyl]amine LC/MS (method A) tR 1.30 min, m/z 302, 304 (M + H, Br isotopes) V-6   [(4-bromo-2-thienyl)methyl][2-(3- fluorophenyl)ethyl]amine LC/MS (method A) tR 1.47 min; m/z 314, 316 (M + H, Br isotopes) V-7   [(4-bromo-2-thienyl)methyl](4,4- dimethylcyclohexyl)amine LC/MS (method A) tR 1.59 min; m/z 303, 305 (M + H, Br isotopes) amine = Ex. III-1

Example V-8 1,1-dimethylethyl {2-[(4-bromophenyl)oxy]ethyl}(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl) carbamate

Step 1: [(4-Bromophenyl)oxy]acetonitrile

A mixture of p-bromophenol (2.61 g; 15.1 mmol), bromoacetonitrile (1.11 mL; 15.9 mmol), and Cs2CO3 (7.40 g; 22.7 mmol) in anhyd MeCN (25 mL) was heated at 80° C., under N2 overnight. The mixture was cooled, filtered through a pad of Celite and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was dissolved in a minimal amount of EtOAc/hexanes and filtered through a short pad of silica gel (EtOAc/hexanes eluent), affording the title compound as a colorless, waxy solid which was used without further purification. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 4.75 (s, 2H), 6.88 (m, 2H), 7.46 (m, 2H).

Step 2: {2-[(4-Bromophenyl)oxy]ethyl}amine

To a solution of [(4-bromophenyl)oxy]acetonitrile (3.07 g; 14.5 mmol; step 1 above) in anhyd THF (10 mL) at 0° C. was added BH3.DMS (18.1 mL of a 2M solution in THF; 36.2 mmol), dropwise over 5 min. The mixture was heated under reflux for 1.5 h, cooled, and 2M HCl (ca. 50 mL) was slowly added. The acidic mixture was extracted with Et2O (×2) and the extracts set aside. NaOH pellets were added to the aqueous residue until ca. pH 14, and the whole was extracted with Et2O (×3). Combined extracts of the basic mixture were washed (brine), dried over Na2SO4, and concentrated in vacuo, affording the first batch of title compound as a pale yellow liquid. The reserved Et2O extracts (from acidic mixture) were concentrated in vacuo, the residue was heated at near reflux in 15 wt % NaOH (aq) for 15 min, cooled, and extracted with CH2Cl2 (×3). Combined organics were washed (brine) and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was slurried in 4M HCl and insoluble material was removed by filtration. The filtrate was extracted with Et2O (×2), pH was adjusted to ca. pH 14 by addition of NaOH pellets and extracted with Et2O (×5). Combined extracts from the basic mixture were washed (brine), dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated in vacuo, affording a second batch of the title compound, which was combined with the first batch. LC/MS (method D) 1.15 min, m/z 216 (M+H, 79Br), 218 (M+H, 81Br).

Step 3: 1,1-Dimethylethyl {2-[(4-bromophenyl)oxy]ethyl}(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)carbamate

To a solution of {2-[(4-bromophenyl)oxy]ethyl}amine (1.89 g; 8.74 mmol; step 2 above), 4,4-dimethylcyclohexanone (1.10 g; 8.74 mmol; Example III-1 Step 1) and HOAc (0.50 mL) in MeOH (50 mL) at rt was added NaBH3CN (0.549 g; 8.74 mmol) in one portion and the mixture was stirred at room temperature. Upon consumption of {2-[(4-bromophenyl)oxy]ethyl}amine (Note 1), volatiles were removed in vacuo and the residue was partitioned between 1M NaOH/CH2Cl2. Layers were separated and the aqueous layer was extracted with CH2Cl2 (×2). Combined organics were washed (H2O, brine), dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was dissolved in CH2Cl2 (40 mL) along with Et3N (1.22 mL; 8.74 mmol), and a solution of (Boc)2O (1.91 g; 8.74 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (10 mL) was added. After 13 h the mixture was diluted with CH2Cl2, washed (H2O, brine), dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a colorless, waxy solid. LC/MS (method A) 3.42 min, m/z 426, 428 (M+H, Br isotopes, 11-12%), 326, 328 ([M-Boc]+H, Br isotopes, 96-100%).

  • Note 1 Reaction progress was monitored by LC/MS; HOAc (˜1 equiv), and small portions of NaBH3CN (0.1-0.25 equiv) and 4,4-dimethylcyclohexanone (0.05 equiv) were added as necessary to effect consumption of the amine.
    The following examples were prepared from the appropriate amines and 4,4-dimethylcyclohexanone (III-1 Step 1) according to the procedure described in Example V-8 Step 3, with any significant deviations noted below table.

TABLE G Compounds of Formula V via reductive alkylation of the corresponding amine and ketone Ex Structure/Name Characterization Data Comments V-9    [(1R)-1-(4-bromophenyl)ethyl](4,4- dimethylcyclohexyl)amine LC/MS (method B) tR 1.93 min; m/z 310, 312 (M + H, Br isotopes) Note 1 V-10   [(1S)-1-(4-bromophenyl)ethyl](4,4- dimethylcyclohexyl)amine LC/MS (method B) tR 1.91 min; m/z 310, 312 (M + H, Br isotopes) Note 1 V-11   1,1-dimethylethyl [(4-bromophenyl) methyl](4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl) carbamate LC/MS (method A) tR 3.36 min, m/z 396, 398 (M + H, Br isotopes, 18- 20%), 340, 342 ([M − C4H8] + H, Br isotopes, 94- 100%) 4-Bromobenzylamine hydrochloride used HOAc omitted from reductive amination. V-12   1,1-Dimethylethyl [2-(4-bromo phenyl)ethyl](4,4-dimethyl cyclohexyl) carbamate LC/MS (method A) tR 3.44 min, m/z 410, 412 (M + H, Br isotopes, 6%), 354 (79Br, 93%), 356 ([M − C4H8] + H, Br isotopes, 93-100%). V-13   1,1-dimethylethyl [(4- bromophenyl)methyl]2,3-dihydro-1H- inden-2-ylcarbamate Note 2 Note 2 Note 1: N—Boc carbamate formation was not observed within 6 h under example conditions. The reaction was worked up per example V-8 Step 3, and the title compound was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes). Note 2: 2-Aminoindane hydrochloride and 4-bromobenzaldehyde were used. The amine hydrochloride was admixed with an eqimolar amount of Et3N in 1:1 THF/MeOH before addition to the aldehyde. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 1.32 (s, 9 H), 2.87-3.03 (m, 4 H), 4.41 (br. s., 2 H), 4.71 (br. s., 1 H), 6.99-7.26 (m, 4 H), 7.44-7.61 (m, 2 H).

Example V-14 1,1-dimethylethyl [2-(3-bromophenyl)ethyl]carbamate

To a solution of 2-bromophenethyl amine (2.0 g, 0.01 mol) in acetonitrile at room temperature was added di-tert-butyl dicarbonate (2.1 g, 0.01 mol) in one portion. After stirring at room temperature for 72 hr the reaction mixture was concentrated in vacuo and the residue was dissolved in ethyl acetate. The solution was washed with brine, dried (Na2SO4), filtered and concentrated in vacuo to give 1,1-dimethylethyl [2-(3-bromophenyl)ethyl]carbamate as a yellow oil. LC/MS (method A) tR 2.73 min; m/z 300 (M+H).

Example V-15 1,1-Dimethylethyl {2-[(4-bromo-3-methylphenyl)oxy]ethyl}carbamate

To a solution of 4-bromo-3-methylphenol (0.187 g; 1.00 mmol), N-Boc aminoethanol (0.39 mL; 2.5 mmol) and PPh3 (0.655 g; 2.5 mmol) in anhyd PhH (5 mL) at 0° C. was added DIAD (0.49 mL; 2.5 mmol), dropwise over 15 min. The mixture was stirred 16 h at room temperature, diluted with Et2O, washed (2×satd Na2CO3, 2×H2O, brine), dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a colorless gum, which solidified on standing. LC/MS (method A) tR 2.95 min, m/z 330, 332 (M+H, Br isotopes, 2%), 352, 354 (M+Na, Br isotopes, 40-43%), 230, 232 ([M-Boc]+H, Br isotopes, 100%).

Example V-16 1,1-Dimethylethyl 6-{[(trifluoromethyl)sulfonyl]oxy}-3,4-dihydro-2(1H)-isoquinolinecarboxylate

Step 1: 1,2,3,4-Tetrahydro-6-isoquinolinol hydrobromide

The title compound was synthesized in two steps from m-methoxyphenethylamine, according to the procedure of Sall, D. J.; Grunewald, G. L. J. Med. Chem. 1987, 30, 2208 with the exception that methyl chloroformate was replaced with ethyl chloroformate in the Bischler-Naperalski cyclization of 3-methoxyphenethylamine to intermediate 6-(methyloxy)-3,4-dihydro-1(2H)-isoquinolinone. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 2.90 (t, J=6.2 Hz, 2H), 3.32 (m, 2H), 4.13 (t, J=4.6 Hz, 2H), 6.59 (d, J=2.2 Hz, 1H), 6.65 (dd, J=8.4, 2.3 Hz, 1H), 7.00 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 1H), 9.00 (br. s, 2H).

Step 2: 1,1-Dimethylethyl 6-hydroxy-3,4-dihydro-2(1H)-isoquinolinecarboxylate

To a slurry of 1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-6-isoquinolinol hydrobromide (1.29 g; 5.63 mmol; step 1 above) and Et3N (3.13 mL; 22.5 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (30 mL) and THF (5 mL) at rt was added a solution of (Boc)2O (2.46 g; 11.3 mmol) in THF (20 mL). The mixture was stirred 72 h at rt and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was dissolved in CH2Cl2 and washed with H2O. The aqueous wash was back-extracted with CH2Cl2 (×2), Combined organics were washed (H2O, brine), dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was dissolved in CH2Cl2 (30 mL), piperidine (30 mL) was added, the mixture was stirred overnight at rt and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was dissolved in EtOAc, washed (3×H2O, brine), dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was re-dissolved in EtOAc, washed (2×1M KHSO4, H2O, brine), dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a colorless gum. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.49 (s, 9H), 2.76 (t, J=5.9 Hz, 2H), 3.61 (br. t, J=5.8 Hz, 2H), 4.49 (s, 2H), 5.58 (br. s, 1H), 6.63 (unresolved d, 1H), 6.68 (br. d, J=8.4 Hz, 1H), 6.95 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 1H).

Step 3: 1,1-dimethylethyl 6-{[(trifluoromethyl)sulfonyl]oxy}-3,4-dihydro-2(1H)-isoquinolinecarboxylate

To a solution of 1,1-dimethylethyl 6-hydroxy-3,4-dihydro-2(1H)-isoquinolinecarboxylate (0.146 g; 0.586 mmol) and Et3N (0.17 mL; 1.2 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (5 mL) at 0° C. was added Tf2O (0.11 mL; 0.67 mmol(, dropwise over 2 min. The mixture was stirred overnight, gradually warming to room temperature, diluted with CH2Cl2, washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a colorless gum which slowly solidified. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.49 (s, 9H), 2.87 (t, J=5.7 Hz, 2H), 3.66 (br. t, J=5.5 Hz, 2H), 4.59 (s, 2H), 7.04-7.12 (m, 2H), 7.18 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 1H).

Example V-17 (u23368-24-1) 1,1-Dimethylethyl 7-{[(trifluoromethyl)sulfonyl]oxy}-3,4-dihydro-2(1H)-isoquinolinecarboxylate

The title compound was obtained from 4-methoxyphenethylamine according to the procedure described for Example V-16, with the exceptions that during N-protection with (Boc)2O (step 2): example V-17 used 1:1 EtOH/1M NaOH as solvent; Et3N was omitted; after stirring 1 h at room temperature, the reaction was concentrated in vacuo, the residue was acidified with 2M KHSO4, extracted with EtOAc, dried and concentrated in vacuo affording the intermediate 1,1-dimethylethyl 7-hydroxy-3,4-dihydro-2(1H)-isoquinolinecarboxylate directly as a tan solid. 7-Hydroxy-intermediate (u22816-72-3): 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.42 (s, 9H), 2.63 (unresolved t, 2H), 3.49 (unresolved t, 2H), 4.38 (br. s, 2H), 6.51 (br. s, 1H), 6.57 (br. d, J=7.9 Hz, 1H), 6.93 (d, J=7.9 Hz, 1H), 9.21 (br. s, 1H). 7-Triflate (title compound): 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.50 (s, 9H), 2.85 (t, J=5.5 Hz, 2H), 3.66 (t, J=5.4 Hz, 2H), 4.59 (s, 2H), 7.03 (unresolved d, 1H), 7.07 (partially resolved dd, Jortho=8.5 Hz, 1H), 7.21 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 1H).

Example V-18: 1,1-Dimethylethyl (4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)(2-{[4-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)phenyl]oxy}ethyl)carbamate

A mixture of {2-[(4-bromophenyl)oxy]ethyl}(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl) carbamate (0.529 g; 1.24 mmol; Example V-8 above), bis(pinacolato)diboron (0.439 g; 1.86 mmol), KOAc (0.365 g; 3.72 mmol), and PdCl2(dppf).CH2Cl2 (0.030 g; 0.037 mmol) in anhyd DMSO (5 mL) was sparged with N2 for 5 min, then heated to 80° C. under N2. After 16.5 h the mixture was cooled, poured into H2O and extracted with EtOAc (×3). Combined organics were washed (H2O, brine), dried over

Na2SO4, adsorbed onto a small amount of silica gel and purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a colorless gum. LC/MS method A) tR 3.50 min, m/z 474 (M+H, 26%), 374 ([M−Boc]+H, 100%).

Example V-19 1,1-dimethylethyl (4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl){[4-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)phenyl]methyl}carbamate

The title compound was synthesized from 1,1-dimethylethyl [(4-bromophenyl)methyl] (4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl) carbamate (Example V-11) according to the procedure described in Example V-18. LC/MS (method A) tR 3.48 min, m/z 444 (M+H, 19%), 466 (M+Na, 100%).

Example V-20:1,1-dimethylethyl 6-(4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolan-2-yl)-3,4-dihydro-2(1H)-isoquinolinecarboxylate

The title compound was prepared from 1,1-dimethylethyl 6-{[(trifluoromethyl)sulfonyl]oxy}-3,4-dihydro-2(1H)-isoquinolinecarboxylate (Example V-16) according to the procedure described in Example V-18. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 1.28 (s, 12H), 1.42 (s, 9H), 2.78 (t, J=6.1 Hz, 2H), 3.54 (t, J=6.0 Hz, 2H), 4.50 (br. s., 2H), 7.16 (d, J=7.8 Hz, 1H), 7.45 (d, J=1.4 Hz, 2H).

Example V-21 5-bromo-N-(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-1-amine

To a slurry of 5-bromo-1-indanone (0.449 g; 2.13 mmol) and 4,4-dimethylcyclohexanamine (2.24 mmol; Note 1) under N2 was added Ti(OiPr)4 (0.94 mL; 3.2 mmol) via syringe. The mixture was stirred 16 h at room temperature, a solution of NaBH3CN (0.134 g; 2.13 mmol) in EtOH (5 mL) was added and stirring continued an additional 4 h. Water was added and the whole was filtered through a pad of Celite (washed 2×EtOH, 2×THF). Combine filtrate and washings were concentrated in vacuo, the residue was taken up in CH2Cl2 and stirred under 1N NaOH for 1 h. Layers were separated, the aqueous layer was extracted with CH2Cl2 (×2), combined organics were washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was dissolved in MeOH/THF/HOAc (15/3/0.3 mL respectively), NaBH3CN (0.134 g; 2.13 mmol) was added and the mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight. After 17 h the mixture was concentrated in vacuo, partitioned between CH2Cl2/1N NaOH and the layers were separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with CH2Cl2 (×2), combined organics were washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes; Note 2), affording the title compound as a pale yellow syrup. LC/MS (method A) tR 1.79 min; m/z 322, 324 (M+H, Br isotopes).

  • Note 1: 4,4-dimethylcyclohexanamine was obtained from an equimolar amount of the hydrochloride salt (Example III-1 Step 1) by partitioning between satd Na2CO3/Et2O, drying the organic layer over Na2SO4, and concentrating in vacuo before use.
  • Note 2: Amine-functionalized silica gel (Teledyne Isco catalog#68-2203-102) was used for purification.

Example V-22: {4-[(2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-ylamino)methyl]-3,5-difluorophenyl}boronic acid

A mixture of 2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine (0.780 mL, 5.99 mmol), (3,5-difluoro-4-formylphenyl)boronic acid (1.0 g, 5.99 mmol) and acetic acid (0.710 mL, 12.0 mmol) in THF (12 mL) was stirred at room temperature for 1 hr. To the solution was added NaBH(OAc)3 (3.81 g, 18.0 mmol) and the mixture stirred at room temperature for 16 hr. The mixture was diluted with EtOAc then washed with satd Na2CO3. The combined layers were filtered and the filter cake washed with H2O and EtOAc to give {4-[(2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-ylamino)methyl]-3,5-difluorophenyl}boronic acid as a beige glass. LC/MS (method A) tR 0.48 min; m/z 304 (M+H).

Compounds of Formula VI

Example VI-1 1,1-dimethylethyl (2-{[4′-(acetylamino)-4-biphenylyl]oxy}ethyl)(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)carbamate

A mixture of 1,1-dimethylethyl {2-[(4-bromophenyl)oxy]ethyl}(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl) carbamate (0.085 g; 0.20 mmol; Example V-8), [4-(acetylamino)phenyl]boronic acid (0.040 g; 0.22 mmol), PdCl2(dppf).CH2Cl2 (0.005 g; 0.006 mmol), Na2CO3 (2 mL of a 2M solution) and DME (2 mL) was sparged with N2 for 10 minutes at room temperature and heated at 80° for 1 h (until consumption of the aryl bromide, as judged by LC/MS). Upon cooling, the mixture was partitioned between EtOAc/H2O, layers were separated and the aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc (×2). Combined organics were washed (brine), dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a pale yellow solid. LC/MS (method A) tR 3.29 min, m/z 481 (M+H, 53%), 381 ([M-Boc]+H, 100%).

The following examples were prepared from the appropriate aryl halide/triflate and aryl boronic acid/ester according to the procedure described for Example VI-1, with any significant deviation noted below table.

TABLE H Compounds of Formula VI from Suzuki coupling of Compounds of Formula IV or V. Ex Structure/Name Characterization Data Comments VI-2    1,1-dimethylethyl (2-{[3′-(acetylamino)- 4-biphenylyl]oxy} ethyl)(4,4- dimethylcyclohexyl) carbamate LC/MS (method A) tR 3.31 min, m/z 481 (M + H, 28%), 381 ([M − Boc] + H, 100%) Aryl bromide V-8 and 3-(acetylamino phenylboronic acid used VI-3    1,1-dimethylethyl (4,4- dimethylcyclohexyl)[2-({3′- [(methylsulfonyl)amino]-4- biphenylyl}oxy)ethyl]carbamate LC/MS (method A) tR 3.26 min, m/z 515 (M − H). Aryl bromide V-8 and 3-[(methylsulfonyl) amino]-phenylboronic acid used VI-4    1,1-dimethylethyl (4,4- dimethylcyclohexyl)(2-{[3′-(1H- imidazol-2-yl)-4-biphenylyl]oxy} ethyl)carbamate LC/MS (method A) tR 2.60 min, m/z 488 (M − H). Aryl bromide IV-21 and aryl boronate V-18 used. VI-5    1,1-dimethylethyl (4,4- dimethylcyclohexyl)(2-{[4′-(1H- imidazol-2-yl)-4-biphenylyl]oxy} ethyl)carbamate LC/MS (method A) 2.55 min; m/z 490 (M + H). Aryl bromide IV-22 and aryl boronate V-18 used. Pd(PPh3)4 used as catalyst VI-6    1,1-dimethylethyl (2-{[5′- (aminocarbonyl)-2′-methyl-4- biphenylyl]oxy}ethyl)(4,4- dimethylcyclohexyl)carbamate LC/MS (method A) tR 3.23 min; m/z 481 (M + H, 24%), 503 (M + Na, 100%).. Aryl bromide IV-1 and aryl boronate V-18 used. VI-7    1,1-dimethylethyl (2-{[3′- (aminocarbonyl)-2′-methyl-4- biphenylyl]oxy}ethyl)(4,4- dimethylcyclohexyl)carbamate LC/MS (method A) tR 3.27 min; m/z 481 (M + H, 5%), 503 (M + Na, 100%).. Aryl bromide IV-2 and aryl boronate V-18 used. VI-8    1,1-dimethylethyl {[3′-(aminocarbonyl)- 4-biphenylyl]methyl}(4,4- dimethylcyclohexyl)carbamate Note 1 Used aryl bromide V- 11 and 3-(aminocarbonyl) phenylboronic acid. VI-9    1,1-dimethylethyl {[4′-(aminocarbonyl)- 4-biphenylyl]methyl}(4,4- dimethylcyclohexyl)carbamate LC/MS (method A) tR 3.09 min; m/z 437 (M + H, 81%), 381 ([M − C4H8] + H, 100%) Used aryl bromide V- 11 and 4-(aminocarbonyl) phenylboronic acid. VI-10   1,1-dimethylethyl {[5′-(aminocarbonyl)- 2′-methyl-4-biphenylyl]methyl}(4,4- dimethylcyclohexyl)carbamate LC/MS (method A) tR 3.21 min; m/z 451 (M + H, 12%), 395 ([M − C4H8] + H, 100%) Used aryl bromide IV- 1 and aryl boronate V- 19. VI-11   1,1-dimethylethyl {[3′-(aminocarbonyl)- 2′-methyl-4-biphenylyl]methyl}(4,4- dimethylcyclohexyl)carbamate LC/MS (method A) tR 3.21 min; m/z 451 (M + H, 25%), 473 (M + Na, 100%), 395 ([M − C4H8] + H, 66%) Used aryl bromide IV- 2 and aryl boronate V-19. VI-12   1,1-dimethylethyl {2-[3′- (aminocarbonyl)-4-biphenylyl] ethyl}(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl) carbamate LC/MS (method A) tR 3.19 min, m/z 451 (M + H, 24%), 901 (2M + H, 100%), 351 ([M − Boc] + H, 30%) Used aryl bromide V- 12 and 3- aminocarbonyl phenylboronic acid VI-13   1,1-dimethylethyl (4,4-dimethyl cyclohexyl)(2-{[3′-(2-oxo-2,3-dihydro- 1H-imidazol-1-yl)-4- biphenylyl]oxy}ethyl)carbamate LC/MS (method E) tR 1.13 min, m/z 450 ({M − C4H8] + H, 100%), 406 ([M − Boc] + H, 55%) Used aryl bromide IV- 35 and aryl boronate V-18. VI-14   1,1-dimethylethyl (4,4- dimethylcyclohexyl)(2-{[3′-(1,1-dioxido- 2-isothiazolidinyl)-4- biphenylyl]oxy}ethyl)carbamate LC/MS (method E) tR 1.12 min, m/z 544 (M + H, 10%), 488 ([M − C4H8] + H, 100%) Used aryl bromide IV- 40 and aryl boronate V -18. Note 1: 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 0.86 (s, 3H), 0.88 (s, 3H), 1.13-1.74 (m, 17 H), 3.42-4.10 (m, 1H), 4.35-4.54 (m, 2H), 5.74 (br. s, 1H), 6.19 (br. s, 1H), 7.30-7.36 (m, 2H), 7.51 (app. t, J = 7.7 Hz, 1H), 7.56 (m, 2H), 7.75 (m, 2H), 8.06 (br. s, 1H).

Example VI-15 1,1-Dimethylethyl (4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)(2-{[3′-(1,2,4-oxadiazol-3-yl)-4-biphenylyl]oxy}ethyl)carbamate

Step 1: 1,1-dimethylethyl {2-[(3′-cyano-4-biphenylyl)oxy]ethyl}(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)carbamate

A mixture of m-cyanophenyl boronic acid (0.086 g; 0.59 mmol), 1,1-dimethylethyl {2-[(4-bromophenyl)oxy]ethyl}(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)carbamate (0.250 g; 0.59 mmol; Example V-8), PdCl2(dppf).CH2Cl2, 2M Na2CO3 (4 mL) and DME (4 mL) was sparged 5 min with N2 and then heated to 80° C. for 5 h. Upon cooling, the mixture was diluted with EtOAc, washed with water and the washing was back-extracted with EtOAc (×2). Combined organics were washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4, adsorbed onto a minimal amount of silica gel and purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a colorless gum. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 0.92 (s, 3H), 0.94 (s, 3H, partially overlapping 0.92), 1.21-1.87 (m, 17H), 3.45-3.63 (m, 2H), 3.88 (br. s, 1H), 4.10 (br. s, 2H), 7.00 (m, 2H), 7.49 (m, 2H), 7.52 (d, J=7.8 Hz, 1H; partially overlapping 7.49), 7.58 (d, J=7.6 Hz, 1H), 7.77 (partially resolved ddd, Jortho=7.8 Hz, 1H), 7.82 (unresolved dd, 1H).

Step 2: 1,1-Dimethylethyl (4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)(2-{[3′-(1,2,4-oxadiazol-3-yl)-4-biphenylyl]oxy}ethyl)carbamate

To a solution of 1,1-dimethylethyl {2-[(3′-cyano-4-biphenyl)oxy]ethyl}(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)carbamate (0.125 g; 0.279 mmol; step 1 above) in EtOH (2.5 mL) at room temperature was added a solution of hydroxylamine (0.25 mL of a 50 wt % aq solution). The mixture was stirred 70 h at room temperature and volatiles were removed in vacuo (1×PhMe chase). The residue was dissolved in trimethyl orthoformate (2 mL), TsOH.H2O (0.0025 g; 0.013 mmol) was added and the mixture was heated at 100° C. in a sealed vial for 1 h. Upon cooling, the mixture was adsorbed onto a small amount of silica gel and purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a colorless gum. LC/MS (method A) tR 3.34 min, m/z 492 (M+H, 5%), 514 (M+Na, 100%), 392 ([M-Boc]+H, 53%).

Example VI-16 1,1-dimethylethyl (4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)[(3′-{[(2-phenylethyl)amino]carbonyl}-4-biphenylyl)methyl]carbamate

Step 1: methyl 4′-[((4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl){[(1,1-dimethylethyl)oxy]carbonyl}amino)methyl]-3-biphenylcarboxylate

A flask equipped with a septum-sealed reflux condenser was charged with 1,1-dimethylethyl [(4-bromophenyl)methyl] (4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)carbamate (0.988 g; 2.49 mmol; Example V-11), {3-[(methyloxy)carbonyl]phenyl}boronic acid (0.493 g; 2.74 mmol), Pd(OAc)2 (0.0028 g; 0.012 mmol) and 2-(2′,6′-dimethoxybiphenyl)di-cyclohexylphosphine (S-Phos; 0.010 g; 0.025 mmol;) was evacuated and back-filled with N2 several times. PhMe/EtOH (4:1 v/v, 7.5 mL), and 2M Na2CO3 were added via syringe through the condensers septum and the mixture was heated under reflux for 2 h (until consumption of the aryl bromide was observed). Upon cooling, the mixture was poured into EtOAc/water, the whole was filtered through a 0.45 μm PTFE membrane filter and the layers were separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc, combined organics were washed (brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a colorless gum/syrup. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 0.85 (s, 6H), 1.07-1.79 (m, 18H), 3.89 (s, 3H), 4.42 (br. s., 2H), 7.36 (d, J=8.03 Hz, 2H), 7.62 (t, J=7.85 Hz, 1H), 7.67 (d, J=8.03 Hz, 2H), 7.95 (t, J=6.96 Hz, 2H), 8.18 (s, 1H).

Step 2: 4′-[((4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl){[(1,1-dimethylethyl)oxy]carbonyl}amino)-methyl]-3-biphenylcarboxylic acid

A mixture of methyl 4′-[((4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl){[(1,1-dimethylethyl)oxy]carbonyl}-amino)methyl]-3-biphenylcarboxylate (0.850 g; 1.88 mmol), LiOH.H2O (0.395 g; 9.40 mmol), water (2 mL) and THF (20 mL) was heated under reflux for 24 h, cooled and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was partitioned between EtOAc/1N KHSO4, layers were separated and the organic layer was extracted with EtOAc (×2). combined organics were washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo affording the title compound as a colorless foam. LC/MS (method E) tR 0.77 min; m/z 464 (M−H).

Step 3: 1,1-dimethylethyl (4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)[(3′-{[(2-phenylethyl)amino]-carbonyl}-4-biphenylyl)methyl]carbamate

To a solution of 4′-[((4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl){[(1,1-dimethylethyl)oxy]carbonyl}amino)-methyl]-3-biphenylcarboxylic acid (0.100 g; 0.23 mmol) in DMF (2 mL) was added DIEA (0.035 mL; 0.25 mmol), and HATU (0.095 g; 0.25 mmol). The solution was aged 5 min at room temperature and phenethylamine (0.031 mL; 0.25 mmol) was added. After 45 min the mixture was partitioned between EtOAc and half-satd Na2CO3, layers were separated and the aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc (×2). Combined organics were washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a colorless gum. LC/MS (method E) tR 1.19 min; m/z 541 (M+H).

The following were prepared from 4′-[((4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl){[(1,1-dimethylethyl)oxy]-carbonyl}amino)methyl]-3-biphenylcarboxylic acid (Example VI-16 Step 2) and the appropriate amines according to the procedure described for Example VI-16 Step 3.

TABLE I Compounds of Formula VI from amide coupling to Example VI-16 Step 2 Ex Structure/Name Characterization Data Comments VI-17   1,1-dimethylethyl (4,4-dimethyl- cyclohexyl)[(3′-{[(3-phenylpropyl)- amino]carbonyl}-4-biphenylyl)- methyl]carbamate LC/MS (method E) tR 1.22 min; m/z 555 (M + H). VI-18   1,1-dimethylethyl (4,4-dimethyl- cyclohexyl)[(3′-{[(phenylmethyl)- amino]carbonyl}-4-biphenylyl)- methyl]carbamate LC/MS (method E) tR 1.17 min; m/z 527 (M + H). VI-19   1,1-dimethylethyl {[3′-({[2-(4- biphenylyl)ethyl]amino}carbonyl)-4- biphenylyl]methyl}(4,4- dimethylcyclohexyl)carbamate LC/MS (method E) tR 1.27 min; m/z 617 (M + H)

Example VI-20 1,1-dimethylethyl 2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl{[3′41H-imidazol-4-yl)-4-biphenylyl]methyl}carbamate

Step 1 1,1-dimethylethyl 2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl[(3′-formyl-4-biphenylyl)-methyl]carbamate

The title compound was prepared from 1,1-dimethylethyl [(4-bromophenyl)methyl]2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-ylcarbamate (Example V-13) and 3-formylphenylboronic acid according to the procedure described in Example VI-16 Step 1. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 1.35 (s, 9H), 3.00 (d, J=8.56 Hz, 4H), 4.51 (br. s., 2H), 7.06-7.19 (m, 4H), 7.34 (d, J=8.03 Hz, 2H), 7.69 (t, J=7.67 Hz, 1H), 7.72-7.77 (m, 2H), 7.86-7.91 (m, 1H), 8.01-8.06 (m, 1H), 8.19-8.24 (m, 1H), 10.10 (s, 1H).

Step 2: 1,1-dimethylethyl 2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl[(3′-{4-[(4-methylphenyl)-sulfonyl]-4,5-dihydro-1,3-oxazol-5-yl}-4-biphenylyl)methyl]carbamate

To a solution of 1,1-dimethylethyl 2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl[(3′-formyl-4-biphenylyl)-methyl]carbamate (0.188 g; 0.44 mmol) and TosMIC (0.086 g; 0.44 mmol) in EtOH at room temperature was added NaCN (0.002 g; 0.04 mmol). The mixture was stirred 30 min, diluted with water and extracted with EtOAc (×3). combined organics were washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo affording the title compound as a colorless gum, used without further purification. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 1.35 (s, 9H), 2.41 (s, 3H), 2.99 (d, J=8.38 Hz, 4H), 4.50 (br. s., 2H), 5.65 (dd, J=5.98, 1.69 Hz, 1H), 5.96 (d, J=5.89 Hz, 1H), 7.07-7.18 (m, 5H), 7.25 (partially resolved dd, J=7.85 Hz, 1H), 7.28-7.34 (m, 2H), 7.40 (unresolved dd, 1H), 7.46-7.52 (m, 3H), 7.57-7.64 (m, 2H), 7.68 (dd, J=8.03, 1.25 Hz, 1H), 7.74 (d, J=1.25 Hz, 1H), 7.83-7.90 (m, 2H).

Step 3: 1,1-dimethylethyl 2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl{[3′-(1H-imidazol-4-yl)-4-biphenylyl]methyl}carbamate

A mixture of 1,1-dimethylethyl 2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl[(3′-{4-[(4-methylphenyl)-sulfonyl]-4,5-dihydro-1,3-oxazol-5-yl}-4-biphenyl)methyl]carbamate (0.260 g; 0.418 mmol) and NH3 in MeOH (5 mL of a 7M solution) was sealed in a pressure tube and heated at 90° C. After 51 h, volatiles were removed in vacuo, a fresh charge of NH3 in MeOH was added to the residue and heating was continued an additional 15 h. Upon cooling, the whole was adsorbed onto a minimal amount of Celite and purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a colorless film. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.42 (s, 9H), 2.94-3.18 (m, J=15.87, 15.79, 15.79, 8.20 Hz, 4H), 4.48 (br. s., 2H), 4.65-5.22 (br. m, 1H), 7.13 (s, 6H), 7.24 (m, 2H), 7.36 (s, 1H), 7.39-7.51 (m, 3H), 7.54-7.60 (m, 2H), 7.64-7.71 (m, 3H), 7.96 (br. s., 1H).

Compounds of Formula VII

Intermediates of Formula VII Intermediate I-VII-1 1,1-Dimethylethyl (2-{[3′-(aminocarbonyl)-2-methyl-4-biphenylyl]oxy}ethyl)carbamate

A mixture of 1,1-dimethylethyl {2-[(4-bromo-3-methylphenyl)oxy]ethyl}carbamate (0.102 g, 0.31 mmol; Example V-15), 3-(aminocarbonyl)phenylboronic acid (0.056 g; 0.34 mmol), PdCl2(dppf).CH2Cl2 (0.0075 g; 0.01 mmol), DME (2 mL) and 2M Na2CO3 (2 mL) was degassed by sparging with N2,(5-10 min) then stirred at 80° C. for 5.5 h. Upon cooling, the mixture was diluted with EtOAc washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a colorless foam. LC/MS (method A) 2.59 min, m/z 371 (M+1, 2%), 392 (M+Na, 53%), 271 ([M−Boc]+H, 100%).

The following intermediates were prepared from the appropriate aryl halide/triflate and aryl boronic acid/boronate according to the procedure described for I-VII-1, with any significant deviations noted below table.

TABLE J Intermediates to Compounds of Formula VII Ex Structure/Name Characterization Data Comments I-VII-2   1,1-dimethylethyl {2-[4′-(amino- carbonyl)-3-biphenylyl]ethyl} carbamate Note 5 Used aryl bromide V- 14 and 4- (aminocarbonyl) phenylboronic acid. Note 1, 2 I-VII-3   1,1-dimethylethyl 4-[4′-(amino- carbonyl)-3-biphenylyl]-1- piperidinecarboxylate Note 6 Used 4(aminocarbonyl) phenyl boronic acid and the corresponding aryl halide. Note 1, 2 I-VII-4   1,1-dimethylethyl {5-[3- (aminocarbonyl)phenyl]-2,3-dihydro- 1H-inden-2-yl}carbamate Note 7 Used product of Ex III-12 Step 1 as aryl bromide and 3-(aminocarbonyl) phenyl boronic acid. Note 3 I-VII-5   1,1-dimethylethyl 6-[3- (aminocarbonyl)-2-methylphenyl]-3,4- dihydro-2(1H)-isoquinolinecarboxylate LC/MS method A 2.61 min; m/z 367 (M + H) Used aryl bromide IV-2 and aryl boronate V-20. Note 3 I-VII-6   1,1-dimethylethyl 6-[3- (aminocarbonyl)-2-fluorophenyl]-3,4- dihydro-2(1H)-isoquinolinecarboxylate LC/MS (method A) 2.6 min; m/z 371 (M + H, 5%), 315 ([M − C4H8] + H, 100%), 271 ([M − Boc] + H, 70%) Used aryl bromide IV-16 and aryl boronate V-20. Note 3 I-VII-7   1,1-dimethylethyl 6-[3-(1H-imidazol-2- yl)phenyl]-3,4-dihydro-2(1H)- isoquinolinecarboxylate LC/MS (method A) 2.02 min; m/z 376 (M + H) Used aryl bromide IV-21 and aryl boronate 20. Note 3 I -VII-8   1,1-dimethylethyl {2-[3′- (aminocarbonyl)-3- biphenylyl]ethyl}carbamate LC/MS (method E) 0.73 min; m/z 341 (M + H) Used aryl bromide V- 14 and 3-(aminocarbonyl)- phenyl boronic acid Note 2, 3, 4. Note 1 1:1 Acetonitrile/0.4M Na2CO3 was used instead of DME/2M Na2CO3. Pd(PPh3)4 was used instead of PdCl2(dppf)•CH2Cl2. Note 2 Chromatographic purification omitted. Note 3 4:1 PhMe/EtOH used instead of DME. Note 4 2-(2′,6′-dimethoxybiphenyl)di-cyclohexylphosphine (S-Phos)/Pd(OAc)2 was used instead of PdCl2(dppf)•CH2Cl2. Note 5 (I-VII-2) 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) delta ppm 1.33 (s, 9 H); 2.75 (t, J = 7.3 Hz, 2 H); 3.19 (m, 2 H); 6.91 (t, J = 5.5 Hz, 1 H); 7.20 (d, J = 7.51, 1 H), 7.38 (m, 2H), 7.53 (m, 2H), 7.72 (d, J = 8.2, 2H), 7.92 (d, J = 8.4, 2H), 8.01 (br. s, 1H). Note 6 (I-VII-3) 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 1.39 (s, 9H), 1.50-1.61 (qd, 2H), 1.78 (br. d, 2H), 2.71-2.77 (br. m, 3H), 4.01-4.09 (br. d, 2H), 7.25 (d, 1H), 7.36-7.40 (m, 2H), 7.52-7.56 (m, 2H), 7.73 (d, 2H), 7.93 (d, 2H), 8.00 (s, 1H). Note 7 (I-VII-4) 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 1.40 (s, 9 H), 2.82 (td, J = 15.1, 7.0 Hz, 2 H), 3.16 (td, J = 14.3, 7.7 Hz, 2 H), 4.26 (app. sext, J = 7.0 Hz, 1 H), 7.21 (d, J = 6.6 Hz, 1 H), 7.29 (d, J = 7.7 Hz, 1 H), 7.43 (br. s., 1 H), 7.46-7.54 (m, 2 H), 7.55 (s, 2 H), 7.77 (d, J = 8.0 Hz, 1 H), 7.82 (d, J = 7.7 Hz, 1 H), 8.07-8.15 (m, 2 H).

Intermediate I-VII-9 1,1-dimethylethyl 6-[3-(aminocarbonyl)phenyl]-3,4-dihydro-2(1H)-isoquinolinecarboxylate

A solution of 3-(aminocarbonyl)phenyl boronic acid (0.663 g; 4.0 mmol), 1,1-dimethylethyl 6-{[(trifluoromethyl)sulfonyl]oxy}-3,4-dihydro-2(1H)-isoquinoline carboxylate (1.28 g; 3.35 mmol; Ex V-16) in DMF (10 mL) was sparged with N2 for 10 min, K3PO4 (1.7 g; 8.0 mmol) and Pd(PPh3)4 (0.193 g; 0.17 mmol) were added and the mixture was stirred at 100° C. for 2 h. Upon cooling, the mixture was poured into water and extracted with EtOAc (×3). Combined organics were washed (H2O, brine), and dried over Na2SO4. Residual solids were collected from the aqueous layer by filtration, air-dried, dissolved in hot EtOH and combined with the dried EtOAc extracts. The whole was adsorbed onto a minimal amount of silica gel and purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a as a colorless solid. LC/MS (method B) 2.69 min; m/z 297 ([M−C4H8]+H, 70%), 253 ([M−Boc]+H, 74%).

Intermediate I-VII-10 1,1-dimethylethyl 7-[4-(amino-carbonyl)phenyl]-3,4-dihydro-2(1H)-isoquinolinecarboxylate

The title compound was prepared from 1,1-dimethylethyl 7-{[(trifluoromethyl)sulfonyl]oxy}-3,4-dihydro-2(1H)-isoquinoline carboxylate (Ex V-17) and 4-(aminocarbonyl)-phenyl boronic acid according to the procedure described for I-VII-9. Tan solid; LC/MS (method A) 2.62 min; m/z 353 (M+H, 75%), 297 ([M-C4H8]+H, 100%).

  • Note Intermediates I-VII-9 and I-VII-10 may also be prepared using conventional biphasic conditions similar to I-VII-1, however, in our hands, the anhydrous conditions described above proved higher yielding for tetrahydroisoquinoline (THiQ) triflates.

Compounds of Formula VII Example VII-1 4′-[(2-Aminoethyl)oxy]-2′-methyl-3-biphenylcarboxamide trifluoroacetate

To a solution of 1,1-dimethylethyl (2-{[3′-(aminocarbonyl)-2-methyl-4-biphenylyl]oxy}ethyl)carbamate (0.090 g; 0.24 mmol; I-VII-2) and Et3SiH (0.1 mL; 0.6 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (5 mL) at room temperature was added TFA (1 mL) in one portion. The mixture was aged 2 h and concentrated in vacuo, affording the title compound as a pale yellow gum which was used without further purification. LC/MS (method A) 1.18 min, m/z 271 (M+H).

Example VII-2 3′(2-aminoethyl)-4-biphenylcarboxamide

To a solution of 1,1-dimethylethyl {2-[4′-(aminocarbonyl)-3-biphenylyl]ethyl}-carbamate (1.81 g, 0.005 mol) in CH2Cl2 (50 mL) at room temperature was added trifluoroacetic acid (15 mL) in one portion. After 1 hr the mixture was cooled in an ice bath and 1M K2CO3 (200 mL) and chloroform were added. The aqueous phase was extracted several times with mixtures of ethyl acetate, dichloromethane and chloroform. Residual solids were collected by filtration, affording the title compound as a white solid; LC/MS (method A) 1.04 min; m/z 241 (M+H). Combined organic extracts were dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo affording an additional batch of the title compound (combined with the solid collected above). This product was used without further purification.

Example VII-3 3′(4-piperidinyl)-4-biphenylcarboxamide hydrochloride

A mixture of 1,1-dimethylethyl 4-[4′-(aminocarbonyl)-3-biphenylyl]-1-piperidine carboxylate (0.95 g, 0.0025 mol; I-VII-3) and 4N HCl in dioxane (5 mL) in dichloromethane (5 mL) was stirred at ambient temperature for 3 hr. The resulting solid was collected by filtration, washed with dichloromethane, diethyl ether and air-dried to give the title compound as a white solid, used without further purification. LC/MS (method A) 1.17 min; m/z 281 (M+H).

Example VII-4 3-(1,2,3,4-tetrahydro-6-isoquinolinyl)benzamide

To a solution of 1,1-dimethylethyl 6-[3-(aminocarbonyl)phenyl]-3,4-dihydro-2(1H)-isoquinolinecarboxylate (0.725 g; 2.20 mmol; I-VII-9) and Et3SiH (0.88 mL; 5.5 mmol) in CH2Cl2 (25 mL) at room temperature was added TFA (10 mL) in one portion. The mixture was aged 3 h and concentrated in vacuo (2×PhMe chase). The residue was partitioned between satd Na2CO3/CHCl3 (Note 1), layers were separated and the aqueous layer was extracted with CHCl3 (×4). Combined organics were washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo, affording the title compound as a colorless solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 2.76 (t, J=5.7 Hz, 2H), 2.96 (t, J=5.8 Hz, 2H), 3.87 (s, 2H), 7.11 (d, J=7.9 Hz, 1H), 7.40-7.48 (m, 3H), 7.51 (t, J=7.8 Hz, 1H), 7.78 (ddd, J=7.7, 1.8, 1.1 Hz, 1H), 7.82 (ddd, J=7.8, 1.4, 1.3 Hz, 1H), 8.10 (s, 1H), 8.12 (t, J=1.6 Hz, 1H).

  • Note 1 A small amount of MeOH was added during extraction with CHCl3 to facilitate dissolution of the solid residue.

Example VII-5 3-(2-amino-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-5-yl)benzamide

The title compound was prepared from 1,1-dimethylethyl {5-[3-(amino-carbonyl)phenyl]-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-yl}carbamate (I-VII-4) according to the procedure described in Example VII-4. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 1.71 (br. s., 2H), 2.55-2.69 (m, 2H), 3.00-3.14 (m, 2H), 3.68-3.77 (m, 1H), 7.28 (d, J=7.7 Hz, 1H), 7.42 (s, 1H), 7.46 (dd, J=7.7, 1.8 Hz, 1H), 7.51 (t, J=7.8 Hz, 1H), 7.54 (s, 1H), 7.77 (app. ddd, J=7.8, 1.8, 1.1 Hz, 1H), 7.82 (app. ddd, J=7.8, 1.7, 1.2 Hz, 1H), 8.10 (br. s., 1H), 8.12 (t, J=1.7 Hz, 1H).

Example VII-6 3′-(2-aminoethyl)-3-biphenylcarboxamide

The title compound was prepared from 1,1-dimethylethyl {2-[3′-(aminocarbonyl)-3-biphenylyl]ethyl}carbamate (I-VII-8) according to the procedure described in Example VII-4. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 1.43 (br. s., 2H), 2.68-2.75 (m, 2H), 2.79-2.85 (m, 2H), 7.23 (d, J=7.7 Hz, 1H), 7.39 (app. t, J=7.8 Hz, 1H), 7.44 (br. s., 1H), 7.50-7.56 (m, 3H), 7.81 (app. ddd, J=7.8, 1.8, 1.2 Hz, 1H), 7.85 (app. ddd, J=7.7, 1.6, 1.1 Hz, 1H), 8.11 (br. s., 1H), 8.14 (app. t, J=1.6 Hz, 1H).

Example VII-7 4′(2-aminoethyl)-3-biphenylcarboxamide

The title compound was prepared from 3-(aminocarbonyl)-phenyl boronic acid and 4-bromophenethylamine according to the procedure described for intermediate I-VII-1 with the exceptions that 4:1 PhMe/EtOH was sued as organic solvent (instead of DME) and the chromatographic purification step was omitted. LC/MS (method E) 0.53 min; m/z 241 (M+H).

Compounds of Formula IX

Formula IX Intermediates

The following compounds were employed as precursors of Formula IX compounds, and at the time of this writing were not readily available from commercial suppliers.

Intermediate I-IX-1 4-bromo-3-methylbenzaldehyde

To a solution of 4-bromo-3-methylbenzonitrile (0.975 g; 5.00 mmol) in anhyd CH2Cl2 (7.5 mL) at −40° C. was added DIBAL-H (7.5 mL of a 1M solution in hexanes; 7.5 mmol), dropwise over 5 min. The mixture was stirred 30 min at −40° C., removed from the cooling bath and stirred 1 h at rt. The mixture was cooled in an ice bath, and excess hydride was quenched by dropwise addition of MeOH. After stirring 20 min, Rochelle's salt (satd aq. solution) was added, the mixture was stirred at rt overnight, and the layers were separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with CH2Cl2 (×2), combined organics were washed (H2O, brine), dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a colorless solid (Note 1). 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 2.49 (s, 1H), 7.56 (dd, J=8.2 Hz, 1.8 Hz, 1H), 7.72 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 1H), 7.74 (d, J=1.7 Hz, 1H, partially overlapping 7.72), 9.96 (s, 1H).

  • Note 1 The title compound was oxidized rapidly on standing in air to a mixture of benzaldehyde and benzoic acid.

Intermediate I-IX-2 4-bromo-2-methylbenzaldehyde

The title compound was prepared from 4-bromo-2-methylbenzonitrile according to the procedure described for Example I-IX-1 with exceptions as follows: the reaction temperature was −78° C. (instead of −40° C.); the reaction was quenched with MeOH at −78° C. (instead of ice bath temp), followed by addition of 6M HCl at −78° C. (instead of satd Rochelle's salt); after quenching the reaction mixture was stirred 30 min at room temperature (instead of overnight). Colorless oil; 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 2.65 (s, 3H), 7.45 (br. s, 1H), 7.51 (dd, J=8.3, 1.7 Hz, 1H), 7.66 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 1H), 10.22 (s, 1H).

Intermediate I-IX-3 4-formyl-2-(methoxy)phenyl trifluoromethanesulfonate

To a solution of 4-hydroxy-3-(methoxy)benzaldehyde (0.760 g; 5.00 mmol) and Et3N (1.39 mL; 10.0 mmol) in anhyd CH2Cl2 (10 mL) at 0° C. was added Tf2O (0.92 mL; 5.5 mmol), dropwise over 2 min. The mixture was allowed to warm slowly to room temperature (overnight), diluted with CH2Cl2, washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a colorless oil. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 4.01 (s, 3H), 7.42 (d, J=8.2 Hz, 1H), 7.52 (dd, J=8.2, 1.8 Hz, 1H), 7.57 (d, J=1.7 Hz, 1H), 9.99 (s, 1H).

Intermediate I-IX-4 (I-17) 2-chloro-4-formylphenyl trifluoromethanesulfonate

The title compound was synthesized from 3-chloro-4-hydroxybenzaldehyde, as described for the synthesis of Example I-IX-3 above. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.56 (d, J=8.5 Hz, 1H), 7.89 (dd, J=8.5 Hz, 1.9 Hz, 1H), 8.07 (d, J=1.9 Hz, 1H), 10.01 (s, 1H).

Intermediate I-IX-5 (I-18) 2-fluoro-4-formylphenyl trifluoromethanesulfonate

The title compound was synthesized from 3-fluoro-4-hydroxybenzaldehyde, as described for the synthesis of Example I-IX-3 above. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 7.56 (m, 1H), 7.80 (m, 2H), 10.01 (d, J=1.5 Hz, 1H).

Intermediate I-IX-6 (I-19) 4-iodo-3-(trifluoromethyl)benzonitrile

To a slurry of 4-amino-3-(trifluoromethyl)benzonitrile (5.48 g; 29.5 mmol) in HBF4 (50 mL; 48%) at −10° C. was added NaNO2 (2.24 g; 32.4 mmol), portionwise over 10 min. The mixture was stirred 30 min, precipitated solids were collected by filtration (Note 1) and (without delay) added portionwise to a solution of KI (7.84 g; 47.2 mmol) in acetone/water (50 mL of a 40% v/v solution). The mixture was decolorized by addition of 10 wt % Na2S2O3, precipitate was collected by filtration, washed with water and slurried in PhMe. The slurry was concentrated to dryness, affording the title compound as a pale orange solid, used without further purification.

1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 7.83 (dd, J=8.1, 1.6 Hz, 1H), 8.27 (d, J=1.5 Hz, 1H), 8.37 (d, J=8.1 Hz, 1H).

  • Note 1 Solid was not allowed to dry completely on the filter.

Intermediate I-IX-7 2-[4-iodo-2-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-1,3-dioxolane

To a solution of 4-iodo-2-(trifluoromethyl)benzonitrile (1.89 g; 6.38 mmol, Note 1) in CH2Cl2 (15 mL) at −40° C. was added DIBAL-H (9.6 mL of a 1.0M solution in CH2Cl2; 9.6 mmol), dropwise over 5 min. The mixture was stirred 30 min, quenched by dropwise addition of MeOH and removed from the cooling bath. To the still-cold mixture was slowly added HCl (10 mL of a 6M solution), and after stirring 30 min at room temperature the layers were separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with CH2Cl2 (×2), combined organics were washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was dissolved in PhH (15 mL), along with TsOH.H2O (0.12 g; 0.64 mmol) and ethylene glycol (3.5 mL; 63 mmol), and the solution was heated under reflux for 2 h using a Dean-Stark trap to remove water. Upon cooling, the mixture was diluted with <solvent>, washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4, and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a pale yellow oil. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 4.00-4.11 (m, 2H), 4.11-4.24 (m, 2H), 6.06 (s, 1H), 7.54 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 1H), 7.93 (d, J=8.4 Hz, 1H), 7.99 (s, 1H).

  • Note 1: 4-iodo-2-(trifluoromethyl)benzonitrile is commercially available from various commercial suppliers; e.g., Apollo Scientific Ltd, Bredbury, Stockport, Cheshire, UK.

Intermediate I-IX-8 4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)-3-(trifluoromethyl)phenylboronic acid

The title compound was prepared from 2-[4-iodo-2-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-1,3-dioxolane (Example I-IX-7) according to the procedure described for Example V-18, with the following exceptions: the aryl iodide and i-PrMgCl were aged 45 min before introduction of the electrophile (instead of 30 min); trimethyl borate was used as the electrophile (instead of 2-isopropoxy-4,4,5,5-tetramethyl-1,3,2-dioxaborolane); the dried organic extracts were concentrated to dryness and triturated with Et2O/hexanes (instead of flash chromatography). White solid. LC/MS (method A) 2.22 min, m/z 417 ({2[M-gylcol]-H2O}—H, 23%), 217 ([M-glycol]-H, 57%), 189 (100%, −ve ion).

Formula IX Compounds Example IX-1 4′-formyl-3-biphenylcarboxamide

A mixture of 4-bromobenzaldehyde (2.78 g; 15.0 mmol), [3-(aminocarbonyl)-phenyl]boronic acid (2.72 g; 16.5 mmol), PdCl2(dppf).CH2Cl2 (0.306 g; 0.38 mmol), DME (25 mL) and Na2CO3 (25 mL of a 2M solution) was sparged 20 min with N2 and heated under reflux for 90 min (consumption of aryl bromide observed by LC/MS). Upon cooling, the mixture was partitioned between EtOAc/H2O, layers were separated, and the aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc (×2). Combined organics were washed (H2O, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a tan solid. LC/MS (method A) 1.91 min, m/z 226 (M+H).

The following examples were prepared from the appropriate aryl halide/triflate and aryl boronic acid/boronate according to the procedure described for example IX-1, with any significant deviations noted below table.

TABLE K Compounds of Formula IX from aryl halides of Formula IV or Intermediates of Formula IX through Suzuki cross-coupling Ex Structure Characterization Data Comments IX-2    4′-formyl-2-methyl-1,1′-biphenyl- 3-carboxamide LC/MS (method A) 1.88 min, m/z 240 (M + H) Used IV-2 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. IX-3    4′-formyl-6-methyl-3- biphenylcarboxamide LC/MS (method A) 2.13 min; m/z 240 (M + H) Used IV-1 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. IX -4    4′-formyl-2′-methyl-3- biphenylcarboxamide LC/MS (method A) 2.05 min; m/z 240 (M + H) Used 3-(aminocarbonyl)- phenyl boronic acid and I- IX-1. IX-5    3′-formyl-3-biphenylcarboxamide LC/MS (method A) 1.90 min; m/z 226 (M + H) Used 3-(amino- carbonyl)phenyl boronic acid and 3-bromobenz- aldehyde. IX-6    3′-formyl-4-biphenylcarboxamide LC/MS (method A) 1.87 min; m/z 226 (M + H) Used 4-(aminocarbonyl)- phenyl boronic acid and 3- bromobenz-aldehyde. IX-7    3′-(1H-imidazol-2-yl)-4- biphenylcarbaldehyde LC/MS (method B) 1.36 min; /z 249 (M + H) Used IV-21 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. Note 1, 2 IX-8    4′-formyl-2′-(methoxy)-3- biphenylcarboxamide LC/MS (method A) 1.94 min; /z 256 (M + H) Used 3-(aminocarbonyl)- phenyl boronic acid and I- IX-3. Note 1, 2 IX-9    2′-chloro-4′-formyl-3- biphenylcarboxamide LC/MS (method A) 2.09 min; m/z 256 (M + H) Used 3-(aminocarbonyl)- phenyl boronic acid and I- IX-4. Note 1,2 IX -10   2′-fluoro-4′-formyl-3- biphenylcarboxamide LC/MS (method A) 1.98 min; m/z 244 (M + H) Used 3-(aminocarbonyl)- phenyl boronic acid and I- IX-5. Note 1, 2 IX-11   4′-formyl-5-methyl-3- biphenylcarboxamide LC/MS (method A) 2.09 min; m/z 240 (M + H) Used IV-9 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. IX-12   2-fluoro-4′-formyl-3- biphenylcarboxamide LC/MS (method B) 1.92 min; m/z 244 (M + H) Used IV-16 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. Note 1, 2 IX-13   2-chloro-4′-formyl-3- biphenylcarboxamide LC/MS (method B) 1.85 min; m/z 260 (M + H) Used IV-13 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. Note 2 IX-14   4′-formyl-2-(methyloxy)-3- biphenylcarboxamide LC/MS (method B) 2.01 min; m/z 256 (M + H) Used IV-14 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. Note 2 IX-15   3′-fluoro-4′-formyl-3- biphenylcarboxamide LC/MS (method A) 1.86 min, m/z 288 (M + H, acetal) 2.02 min; m/z 244 (M + H aldehyde) Used IV-6 and 3-fluoro-4- formyl-phenyl boronic acid (Aldrich). Note 2, 7, 10 IX-16   4′-formyl-3′-methyl-3- biphenylcarboxamide LC/MS (method A) 2.09 min; m/z 240 (M + H) Used 3-(aminocarbonyl)- phenyl boronic acid and I- IX-2 Note 2 IX-17   4′-formyl-4-methyl-3- biphenylcarboxamide LC/MS (method A) 1.96 min; m/z 240 (M + H) Used IV-3 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. Note 2 IX-18   4′-(1H-imidazol-2-yl)-3- biphenylcarbaldehyde Note 8 Used IV-22 and 3- formylphenyl boronic acid. Note 2 IX-19   3-(5-formyl-2-pyridinyl)- benzamide LC/MS (method B) 1.63 min; m/z 227 (M + H) Used 3-(aminocarbonyl)- phenyl boronic acid and 3- formyl-6-bromopyridine. Note 2 IX-20   2-(4′-formyl-1,1′-biphenyl-3- yl)acetamide LC/MS (method B) 2.04 min, m/z 240 (M + H) Used IV-15 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. Note 2 IX-21   3′-(5-amino-3-isoxazolyl)-4- biphenylcarbaldehyde LC/MS (method B) 2.27 min; m/z 265 (M + H) Used IV-34 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. Note 2, 3 IX-22   2,3′-difluoro-4′-formyl-3- biphenylcarboxamide Note 9 Used IV-16 and 3-fluoro- 4-formyl-phenyl boronic acid (Aldrich). Note 2, 3 IX-23   3′-formyl-2-methyl-4- biphenylcarboxamide LC/MS (method A) 1.99 min; m/z 240 (M + H) Used IV-4 and 3- formylphenyl boronic acid. Note 2, 4 IX-24   3-chloro-3′-formyl-4-biphenyl carboxamide. LC/MS (method A) 1.92 min; m/z 260 (M + H) Used IV-7 and 3- formylphenyl boronic acid. Note 2, 4 IX-25   3′-formyl-2-(methyloxy)-4- biphenylcarboxamide. LC/MS (method A) 1.94 min; m/z 256 (M + H) Used IV-19 and 3- formylphenyl boronic acid. Note 2, 4 IX-26   2-chloro-3′-formyl-4-biphenyl carboxamide. LC/MS (method A) 2.07 min; m/z 260 (M + H) Used IV-20 and 3- formylphenyl boronic acid. Note 2, 4, 5 IX-27   4′-fluoro-3′-formyl-4- biphenylcarboxamide. LC/MS (method A) 1.99 min; m/z 244 (M + H) Used 2-fluoro-5- bromobenzaldehyde and 4-(amino-carbonyl)phenyl boronic acid. Note 2, 4 IX-28   2′-fluoro-3′-formyl-4- biphenylcarboxamide. LC/MS (method A) 2.05 min; m/z 244 (M + H) Used and 2-fluoro-3 - formylboronic acid. Note 2, 4 IX-29   2′-fluoro-5′-formyl-4- biphenylcarboxamide. LC/MS (method A) 1.95 min; m/z 244 (M + H) Used 3-bromo-4- fluorobenzaldehyde and 4-(aminocarbonyl phenyl)boronic acid. Note 2, 4 IX-30   3′-chloro-5′-formyl-4- biphenylcarboxamide. LC/MS (method A) 2.25 min; m/z 260 (M + H) Used 3-bromo-5- chlorobenzaldehyde and 4-(aminocarbonyl phenyl)boronic acid. Note 2, 4 IX-31   2′-fluoro-3′-formyl-2-methyl-4- biphenylcarboxamide. LC/MS (method A) 2.04 min; m/z 258 (M + H) Used IV-4 and 2-fluoro-3- formylphenyl boronic acid. Note 2, 4 IX-32   5′-formyl-2′-(methyloxy)-4- biphenylcarboxamide. LC/MS (method B) 1.91 min; m/z 256 (M + H) Used 4-bromo-benzamide and 5-formyl-2-methoxy- phenyl boronic acid. Note 2, 4 IX-33   3′-(1,1-dioxidoiso-thiazolidin-2- yl)-1,1′-biphenyl-4-carbaldehyde LC/MS (Method E) 0.79 min; m/z 302 (M + H) Note 2 IX-34   3′-(2-oxo-2,3-dihydro-1H- imidazol-1-yl)-1,1′-biphenyl-4- carbaldehyde LC/MS (Method E) 0.78 min; m/z 265 (M + H) Used IV-35 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. IX-35   3′-(5-oxo-1,5-dihydro-4H-1,2,4- triazol-4-yl)-1,1′-biphenyl-4- carbaldehyde LC/MS (Method E) 0.73 min; m/z 266 (M + H) Used IV-36 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. Note 2, 6 IX-36   3′-(2,4-dioxoimidazolidin-1-yl)- 1,1′-biphenyl-4-carbaldehyde LC/MS (Method E) 0.76 min; m/z 281 (M + H) Used IV-37 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. Note 2, 6 IX-37   3′-(2-oxoimidazolidin-1 -yl)-1,1′- biphenyl-4-carbaldehyde LC/MS (Method E) 0.81 min; m/z 267 (M + H) Used IV-38 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. IX-38   3′-(1,1-dioxido-1,2,5- thiadiazolidin-2-yl)-1,1′-biphenyl- 4-carbaldehyde LC/MS (method E) 0.67 min; m/z 303 (M + H) Used IV-39 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. IX-39 LC/MS (method A) 1.90 min; m/z 278 (M + H). Used IV-13and 3-fluoro- 4-formyl-phenyl boronic acid (Aldrich) IX-40   3-(6-formyl-3-pyridinyl)- benzamide LC/MS (method B) 1.54 min; m/z 227 (M + H) Used 5-bromo-2- formylpyridine and 3- (aminocarbonyl)phenyl boronic acid. Note 1 Used 4:1 v/v PhMe/EtOH as organic cosolvents (instead of DME). Note 2 Used Pd(PPh3)4 as catalyst (instead of PdCl2(dppf)•CH2Cl2). Note 3 Used Pd(OAc)2/S-Phos as catalyst(instead of PdCl2(dppf)•CH2Cl2). Note 4 Used acetonitrile/0.4M Na2CO3 instead of DME/2M Na2CO3. Note 5 Used K3PO4 as base and dioxane as solvent instead of (Na2CO3/DME). Note 6 Heterocycle N-deprotection (TFA/CH2Cl2/RT) immediately following Suzuki reaction. Note 7 In several cases, a (dimethyl)acetal and/or hemi-acetal of the title compound was observed by LC/MS, in addition to the expected title compound (presumably formed on the column from MeOH mobile phase, or sample solvent, and TFA mobile phase additive. Note 8 (Ex IX-18) 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 7.17 (br. s., 3 H), 7.71 (t, J = 7.67 Hz, 1 H), 7.84-7.88 (m, 2 H), 7.91 (ddd, J = 7.71, 1.29, 1.16 Hz, 1 H), 8.03-8.12 (m, 4 H), 8.07 (d, J = 8.56 Hz, 3 H), 8.28 (t, J = 1.61 Hz, 1 H), 10.11 (s, 1 H), 12.62 (br. s., 1 H) Note 9 (Ex IX-22) 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 7.40 (t, J = 7.69 Hz, 1 H), 7.62 (ddd, J = 13.37, 1.70, 1.30 Hz, 1 H), 7.65 (dt, J = 17.21, 1.70, 1.35 Hz, 1 H), 7.68-7.75 (m, J = 7.65, 7.58, 7.58, 1.74 Hz, 3 H), 7.84 (br. s., 1 H), 7.96 (t, J = 7.69 Hz, 1 H), 10.27 (s, 1 H) Note 10 An alternate preparation of example IX-15 is given below.

Example IX-15 3′-fluoro-4′-formyl-3-biphenylcarboxamide (Alternate Preparation)

A 10 mL conical vial equipped with magnetic spin vane was charged with 3-bromobenzamide (0.200 g; 1.00 mmol; Ex IV-6), 3-fluoro-4-formyl-phenyl boronic acid (0.185 g; 1.1 mmol), tetra-n-butyl ammonium bromide (0.323 g; 1.0 mmol), Pd(OAc)2 (0.0011 g; 0.005 mmol), K2CO3 (0.345 g; 2.5 mmol) and sealed with a septum. The vial was evacuated/backfilled with nitrogen (×3), water was added via syringe and the mixture was stirred at 80° C. for 2.5 h. Upon cooling, the mixture was poured into water, layered with Et2O and sonicated ca. 2 min. Solid was collected by filtration and washed with Et2O, affording the title compound as a cream-colored solid (used without further purification). LC/MS (method A) 2.02 min; m/z 244 (M+H).

The following examples were prepared from the appropriate aryl halide/triflate and aryl boronic acid/boronate according to the procedure described above for example IX-15, with any significant deviations noted below table.

TABLE L Compounds of Formula IX from Suzuki reaction conditions used in Example IX-15 Ex Structure Characterization Data Comments IX-41   3′,5′-difluoro-4′-formyl-3- biphenylcarboxamide LC/MS (method A) 1.86, 2.02 min; m/z 308 (M + H acetal, 1.86 min) 262 (M + H aldehyde, 2.02 min) Used 3- (aminocarbonyl)- phenyl boronic acid and 4-bromo-2,6- difluorobenz-aldehyde. Note 1, 2 IX-42   3′,5-difluoro-4′-formyl-3- biphenylcarboxamide LC/MS (method A) 2.02, 2.16 min; m/z 308 (M + H acetal, 2.02 min) 260 (M − H aldehyde, 2.16 min) Used IV-17 and 3- fluoro-4-formyl-phenyl boronic acid (Aldrich). Note 2 IX-43   4′-formyl-N-methyl-3- biphenylcarboxamide LC/MS (method B) 2.05 min; m/z 240 (M + H) Used 3-(methyl- carbamoyl)phenyl boronic acid (Combi- Blocks) and 4-bromo- benzaldehyde. IX-44   3′-chloro-4′-formyl-3- biphenylcarboxamide LC/MS (method A) 2.08, 2.29 min; m/z 306 (M + H acetal, 2.08 min) 260 (M − H aldehyde, 2.29 min) Used 3-(amino- carbonyl)phenyl boronic acid and 4- bromo-2-chloro- benzaldehyde. Note 2, 3 Note 1 4-bromo-2,6-difluorobenzaldehyde is commercially available from various suppliers; e.g., Apollo Scientific Ltd., Bredbury, Stockport, Cheshire, UK. Example IX-39 has also been prepared from 3-bromobenzamide (IV-6) and 3,5-difluoro-4-formylphenyl boronic acid (Aldrich), according to the procedure described for example IX-1, using Pd(OAc)2/S-Phos as catalyst and PhMe/EtOH (4:1) as organic cosolvent. Note 2 In several cases, a (dimethyl)acetal and/or hemi-acetal of the title compound was observed by LC/MS, in addition to the expected title compound (presumably formed on the column from MeOH mobile phase, or sample solvent, and TFA mobile phase additive. Note 3 4-bromo-2-chlorobenzaldehyde is commercially available from various suppliers; e.g., Apollo Scientific Ltd., Bredbury, Stockport, Cheshire, UK.

Example IX-45 5-(4-formylphenyl)-3-pyridinecarboxamide

A mixture of 5-bromonicotinamide (0.201 g; 1.00 mmol), 4-formylphenyl boronic acid (0.180 g; 1.2 mmol), Pd(OAc)2 (0.0022 g; 0.010 mmol), S-Phos (0.0082 g; 0.020 mmol) and K2CO3 (0.345 g; 2.5 mmol) in n-butanol (3 mL) was sparged with nitrogen ca. 10 min, then heated at 80° C. for 1 h. Upon cooling, the mixture was poured into water, layered with Et2O and sonicated at room temperature ca. 5 min. Solid was collected by filtration, and the cake was air-dried on the filter, affording the title compound as a colorless solid which was used without further purification. LC/MS (method A) 1.57 min; m/z 227 (M+H).

The following examples were prepared from the appropriate aryl halide/triflate and aryl boronic acid/boronate according to the procedure described for example IX-45, with any significant deviations noted below table.

TABLE M Compounds of Formula IX from Suzuki cross-coupling conditions described in IX-45 Ex Structure/Name Characterization Data Comments IX-46 LC/MS (method B) (hemiacetal) 1.96 min; m/z 312 (M + H) (aldehyde) 2.08 min; m/z 280 (M + H) Used IV-16 and 2,3- difluoro-4-formyl- phenyl boronic acid (Aldrich). Note 1, 2, 4 IX-47 LC/MS (method A) (acetal) 2.00 min, m/z 308 (M + H) (aldehyde) 2.12 min; m/z 262 (M + H) Used IV-6 and 2,3- difluoro-4-formyl- phenyl boronic acid (Aldrich). Note 1, 3, 4 IX-48 LC/MS (method A) 2.15 min; m/z 242 (M − H) Used IV-17 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. IX-49 LC/MS (method B) 2.32 min; m/z 260 (M + H) Used IV-8 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. Note 2 IX-50 LC/MS (method A) 2.38 min; m/z 292 (M − H) Used IV-10 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. IX-51 LC/MS (method A) 1.87 min; m/z 227 (M + H) Used IV-11 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. IX-52 LC/MS (method A) 1.65 min; m/z 227 (M + H) Used commercially available 2-chloro isonicotinamide from Maybridge Building Blocks and 4-formylphenyl boronic acid. IX-53 LC/MS (method A) 2.03 min; m/z 258 (M + H) Used IV-2 and 3- fluoro-4- formylphenyl boronic acid (Aldrich). Note 1 K3PO4 was used as base (instead of K2CO3). PhMe was used as solvent (instead of n-butanol), reaction temperature was 90° C. (instead of 80° C.). Note 2 Product was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes). Note 3 An additional portion of the aryl boronic acid (0.5 equiv) was added after 5 h heating. Total reaction time was 21 h. Note 4 In several cases, the title compounds were accompanied by the corresponding (dimethyl)acetals, presumably formed on the column from MeOH moblie phase (or sample solvent) and the trace acid mobile phase additive (TFA).

Example IX-54 4′-formyl-2′-(trifluoromethyl)-3-biphenylcarboxamide

Step 1: 4′-cyano-2′-(trifluoromethyl)-3-biphenylcarboxamide

The title compound was synthesized from 3-(aminocarbonyl)phenyl boronic acid and 4-iodo-3-(trifluoromethyl)benzonitrile (I-IX-6) according to the procedure described for Ex IX-10, using Pd(PPh3)4 catalyst and PhMe/EtOH (4:1) as organic cosolvents. LC/MS (method A) 2.18 min, m/z 291 (M+H).

Step 2: 4′-formyl-2′-(trifluoromethyl)-3-biphenylcarboxamide

To a solution of 4′-cyano-2′-(trifluoromethyl)-3-biphenylcarboxamide (0.239 g; 1.01 mmol; step 1 above) in CH2Cl2 (10 mL) at −78° C. was added DIBAL-H (2.5 mL of a 1.0M solution in CH2Cl2; 2.5 mmol), dropwise over 3 min. After 15 min the reaction was quenched by addition of 6M HCl (ca. 5 mL), removed from the cooling bath and stirred at room temperature for 20 min. The mixture was poured into water and extracted with CH2Cl2 (×3). Combined organics were filtered through a pad of Celite, washed (satd NaHCO3, brine), dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a colorless gum. LC/MS (method B) 2.21 min, m/z 294 (M+H).

Example IX-55 4′-formyl-3′-(trifluoromethyl)-1,1-biphenyl-3-carboxamide

Step 1: 4′-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)-3′-(trifluoromethyl)-1,1-biphenyl-3-carboxamide

The title compound was prepared from 3-(aminocarbonyl)phenyl boronic acid and 2-[4-iodo-2-(trifluoromethyl)phenyl]-1,3-dioxolane (I-IX-7) according to the procedure described for IX-10, using PhMe/EtOH (4:1) as organic cosolvents. Colorless solid. LC/MS (method A) 2.38 min; m/z 338 (M+H).

Step 2: 4′-formyl-3′-(trifluoromethyl)-1,1-biphenyl-3-carboxamide

4′-(1,3-Dioxolan-2-yl)-3′-(trifluoromethyl)-1,1′-biphenyl-3-carboxamide (0.177 g; 0.525 mmol) was added to a solution of HOAc (4 mL) and water (1 mL) and the mixture was stirred at 65° C. in a sealed vial for 1 h. Upon cooling, the mixture was poured into satd NaHCO3 and extracted with EtOAc (×3). Combined organics were washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo affording the title compound, which was used without further purification.

1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 7.55 (br. s., 1H), 7.64 (t, J=7.76 Hz, 1H), 7.98 (ddd, J=7.98, 1.38, 1.16 Hz, 1H), 8.02 (ddd, J=7.76, 1.87, 1.07 Hz, 1H), 8.18-8.26 (m, 3H), 8.29 (dd, J=8.03, 1.78 Hz, 1H), 8.31 (t, J=1.69 Hz, 1H), 10.31 (q, J=1.96 Hz, 1H)

Example IX-56 4′-formyl-2-methyl-3′-(trifluoromethyl)-3-biphenyl-carboxamide

Step 1: 4′-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)-3′-(trifluoromethyl)-3-biphenylcarboxamide

The title compound was prepared from 3-bromo-2-methylbenzamide (Ex IV-2) and 4-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)-3-(trifluoromethyl)phenylboronic acid (I-IX-8) according to the procedure described in Example IX-10, using PhMe/EtOH (4:1) as organic colsovent. LC/MS (method A) 2.36 min; m/z 351 (M+H).

Step 2: 4′-formyl-2-methyl-3′-(trifluoromethyl)-3-biphenylcarboxamide

The title compound was prepared from 4′-(1,3-dioxolan-2-yl)-3′-(trifluoromethyl)-3-biphenylcarboxamide (Step 1 above) according to the procedure described for example IX-55, Step 2. LC/MS (method A) 2.33 min; m/z 308 (M+H).

Example IX-57 3′-(1H-pyrazol-3-yl)-4-biphenylcarbaldehyde

Step 1: [3-(4′-formyl-3-biphenylyl)-1H-pyrazol-1-yl]methyl 2,2-dimethyl-propanoate

The title compound was prepared from 3-(3-bromophenyl)-1H-pyrazol-1-yl]methyl 2,2-dimethylpropanoate (Ex IV-29) and 4-formylphenyl boronic acid according to the procedure described for IX-10, using PhMe/EtOH (4:1) as organic cosolvents. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 1.12 (s, 9H), 6.11 (s, 2H), 6.99 (d, J=2.50 Hz, 1H), 7.57 (t, J=7.67 Hz, 1H), 7.74 (ddd, J=7.85, 1.96, 1.07 Hz, 1H), 7.91 (ddd, J=7.76, 1.61, 1.16 Hz, 1H), 7.96-8.00 (m, 3H), 8.01-8.05 (m, 2H), 8.18 (t, J=1.61 Hz, 1H), 10.07 (s, 1H).

Step 2: 3′-(1H-pyrazol-3-yl)-4-biphenylcarbaldehyde

To a solution of [3-(4′-formyl-3-biphenylyl)-1H-pyrazol-1-yl]methyl 2,2-dimethyl-propanoate (0.162 g; 0.45 mmol) in 1:1 THF/MeOH (5 mL total vol) at room temperature was added NaOH (1.1 mL of a 1.0M solution; 1.1 mmol). After 30 min, HOAc (0.08 mL; 1.4 mmol) was added and the mixture was concentrated in vacuo. The residue was partitioned between EtOAc/water, layers were separated, the organic layer was washed (satd NaHCO3, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was redissolved in EtOAc, washed (1M HCl, water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo, affording the title compound as a glassy semi-solid which was used without further purification. LC/MS (method A) 2.42 min; m/z 249 (M+H).

Compounds of Formula X

Intermediates of Formula X

The following compounds were employed as precursors of Formula X compounds wherein Y is a suitably protected heteroaryl or heterocyclyl, cyano or ester, and at the time of this writing were not readily available from commercial suppliers.

Intermediate I-X-1 3′-[1-({[2-(trimethylsilyl)ethyl]oxy}methyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazol-3-yl]-4-biphenylcarbaldehyde and 3′-[1-({[2-(trimethylsilyl)ethyl]-oxy}methyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazol-5-yl]-4-biphenylcarbaldehyde

A mixture of 4-formylphenyl boronic acid (0.110 g; 0.737 mmol), 3-(3-bromophenyl)-1-({[2-(trimethylsilyl)ethyl]oxy}methyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazole and 5 (3-bromophenyl)-1-({[2-(trimethylsilyl)ethyl]oxy}methyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazole (0.236 g; 0.667 mmol, Ex V-23), Pd(PPh3)4 (0.039 g; 0.033 mmol), 2M Na2CO3 (0.80 mL; 1.6 mmol) and PhMe/EtOH (4:1, 8 mL) was sparged with N2 for 10 min and heated under reflux for 16 h. Upon cooling, the mixture was diluted with EtOAc and washed with water. The aqueous wash was back-extracted with EtOAc (×2), combined organics were washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compounds as partially-resolved mixture. LC/MS (method B) isomer 1: 2.97 min, m/z 380 (M+H). LC/MS (method B) isomer 2:3.02 min; m/z 380 (M+H). These regioisomers were combined, and carried on as a mixture.

Intermediate I-X-2 [3-(4′-formyl-3-biphenylyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazol-1-yl]methyl 2,2-dimethylpropanoate

A vial equipped with magnetic spin vane was charged with [[3-(3-Bromophenyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazol-1-yl]methyl 2,2-dimethylpropanoate (0.203 g; 0.60 mmol; Ex IV-24), 4-formylphenyl boronic acid (0.099 g; 0.66 mmol), and PdCl2(dppf).CH2Cl2 (0.012 g; 0.015 mmol), was sealed with a septum and evacuated/backfilled with N2 (×3). PhMe/EtOH (4:1, 3 mL) and 2M Na2CO3 (0.72 mL; 1.44 mmol) were added through the septum via syringe and the mixture was stirred at 80° C. for 2.5 h. Upon cooling, the mixture was partitioned between EtOAc/water and the layers were separated. The aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc (×2), combined organics were washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a colorless gum/film. LC/MS (method A) 2.60 min; m/z 364 (M+H).

The following intermediates were prepared from the appropriate aryl halide/triflate and aryl boronic acid/boronate ester according to the procedure described for intermediate I-X-2, with any significant deviation noted below table.

TABLE N Compounds of Formula X from Suzuki cross-coupling similar to that described in I-X-2 Ex Structure/Name Characterization Data Comments I-X-3  LC/MS (method B) 2.76 (min; m/z 364 (M + H) Used IV-33 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. I-X-4  LC/MS (method A) acetal: 2.58 min; m/z 448 (M + H) aldehyde: 2.74 min; m/z 416 (M + H) Used IV-28 and 3- fluoro-4-formyl-phenyl boronic acid. Note 1 I-X-5  LC/MS (method A) 2.7 min; m/z 378 (M + H) Used IV-27 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. I-X-6  LC/MS (method A) 2.65 min; m/z 382 (M + H) Used IV-26 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. I-X-7  LC/MS (method A) 2.63 min; m/z 398 (M + H) Used IV-28 and 4- formylphenyl boronic acid. I-X-8  LC/MS (method A) hemiacetal: 2.67 min, m/z 414 (M + H); aldehyde: 2.85 min, m/z 382 (M + H). Used IV-24 and 3- fluoro-4-formyl-phenyl boronic acid. Note 1 I-X-9  Note 2 Used IV-24 and 3,5- difluoro-4-formyl- phenyl boronic acid. Note 2 I-X-10 Note 4 Used IV-30 and 2- fluoro-3-formyl-phenyl boronic acid. Note 3 I-X-11 Note 5 Used IV-32 and 2- fluoro-3-formyl phenyl boronic acid. Note 3 Also prepared by microwave heating. I-X-12 Note 6 Used IV-31 and 2- fluoro-3-formylphenyl boronic acid. Note 3 I-X-13 Note 7 Used IV-30 and 2,4- difluoro-3-formyl phenyl boronic acid. Note 3 I-X-14 Note 8 Used IV-24 and 2,4- difluoro-3- formylphenyl boronic acid. Note 3 I-X-15 LC/MS (method B) 0.87 min; m/z 382 (M + 1) Used IV-24 and 3- formylphenyl boronic acid. Note 3 I-X-16 LC/MS (method B) 0.88 min; m/z 382 (M + 1) Used IV-24 and 4- fluoro-3-formyl-phenyl boronic acid. Note 3 Note 1 In several cases, a (dimethyl)acetal and/or hemi-acetal of the title compound was observed by LC/MS, in addition to the expected title compound; presumably formed on the column from MeOH mobile phase, or sample solvent, and TFA mobile phase additive. Note 2 Pd(OAc)2/S-Phos was used as catalyst. An alternate preparation of I-X-8 is given below. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 1.13 (s, 9H), 6.21 (s, 2H), 7.65 (app. t, J = 7.94 Hz, 1H), 7.67-7.72 (m, 2H), 7.91 (app. ddd, J = 7.85, 1.96, 1.07 Hz, 1H), 8.13 (app. dd, J = 7.94, 1.34 Hz, 1H), 8.34 (app. t, J = 1.52 Hz, 1H), 8.83 (s, 1H), 10.25 (s, 1H). Note 3 Used 2 equiv aryl boronic acid. Note 4 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.20 (s, 9H), 6.10 (s, 2H), 7.35 (t, J = 7.69 Hz, 1H), 7.60-7.69 (m, 2H), 7.74 (td, J = 7.51, 1.83 Hz, 1H), 7.84-7.92 (m, 1H), 8.23 (d, J = 8.30 Hz, 2H), 8.39 (s, 1H), 10.46 (s, 1H). Note 5 (I-X-11) 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.19 (s, 9H), 6.09 (s, 2H), 7.36 (t, J = 7.69 Hz, 1H), 7.48 (t, J = 7.69 Hz, 1H), 7.68 (t, J = 6.84 Hz, 1H), 7.88-8.07 (m, 3H), 8.39 (s, 1H), 10.44 (s, 1H). Note 6 (I-X-12) 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.19 (s, 9H), 2.28 (s, 3H), 6.10 (s, 2H), 7.27-7.39 (m, 2H), 7.54 (td, J = 7.20, 1.46 Hz, 1H), 7.85-7.94 (m, 1H), 8.02 (d, J = 8.06 Hz, 1H), 8.09 (s, 1H), 8.38 (s, 1H), 10.43 (s, 1H). Note 7 (I-X-13) 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.19 (s, 9H), 6.09 (s, 2H), 7.09 (t, J = 9.16 Hz, 1H), 7.59 (d, J = 6.84 Hz, 2H), 7.69 (td, J = 8.48, 6.23 Hz, 1H), 8.22 (d, J = 8.30 Hz, 2H), 8.38 (s, 1H), 10.43 (s, 1H). Note 8 (I-X-14) 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.19 (s, 9H), 6.09 (s, 2H), 7.08 (t, J = 9.28 Hz, 1H), 7.53-7.59 (m, 2H), 7.73 (td, J = 8.48, 6.23 Hz, 1H), 8.14-8.21 (m, 1H), 8.25 (s, 1H), 8.39 (s, 1H), 10.43 (s, 1H).

Alternate preparation of Intermediate I-X-9 [3-(3′,5′-difluoro-4′-formyl-3-biphenylyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazol-1-yl]methyl 2,2-dimethylpropanoate

A flask was charged with PhMe/EtOH (4:1, 50 mL), water (25 mL) and NaHCO3 (3.78 g; 45 mmol) and the mixture was sparged with N2 for 15 min in an ultrasonic bath. [3-(3-bromophenyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazol-1-yl]methyl 2,2-dimethylpropanoate (5.07 g; 15.0 mmol; Ex IV-24), 3,5-difluoro-4-formyl-phenyl boronic acid (3.07 g; 16.5 mmol) and PdCl2(dppf).CH2Cl2 (0.245 g; 0.30 mmol) were added in one portion and the mixture was heated under reflux for 10 h. Upon cooling, solids were collected by filtration, washed (Et2O/hexane), dissolved in hot EtOAc and filtered without delay through a short pad of silica get (1:1 EtOAc/hexanes eluent). Filtrate collected from the reaction mixture was diluted with water/EtOAc, separated and the aqueous layer extracted with EtOAc (×3). Combined organics were washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue obtained from the extracts was dissolved in hot EtOAc, filtered through silica (1:1 EtOAc/hexanes eluent), and the filtrate combined with that obtained from the crude reaction mixture solids. Combined filtrates were concentrated in vacuo, affording the title compound as a pale yellow solid.

In another preparation of the title compound, Pd(OAc)2/S-Phos (0.005/0.010 equiv) were used as catalyst, NaHCO3 (3 equiv) was used as base, and PhMe/water were used as solvents (without EtOH additive), reaction time 3 h/85° C. Product I-X-9 was isolated in a manner analogous to the above procedure.

Choice of base appears to be a key parameter in the cross-coupling of Ex. IV-24 under typical biphasic conditions. In our hands, NaHCO3 was an effective and reliable base for preparation of I-X-9. On some occasions, the use of Na2CO3, as base resulted in stalled reactions; mixtures of IV-24 and I-X-9 were returned, accompanied by varying amounts of deprotected IV-24 (i.e., 3-bromo phenyl-1H-1,2,4-triazole).

Intermediate I-X-17 [3-(3′-formyl-4-biphenylyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazol-1-yl]methyl 2,2-dimethylpropanoate

To a solution of [3-(4-bromophenyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazol-1-yl]methyl 2,2-dimethyl-propanoate (0.108 g, 0.32 mmol; IV-30), 3-formylphenyl boronic acid (0.099 g, 0.66 mmol), and PdCl2(dppf).CH2Cl2 (0.024 g, 0.029 mmol) was added 2M Na2CO3 (aq) (0.38 mL, 0.76 mmol). The mixture was subjected to microwave heating (135° C./50 min), cooled, and partitioned between EtOAc and water. The aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc, combined organic extracts were dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), affording the title compound as a colorless solid. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.20 (s, 9H), 6.10 (s, 2H), 7.63 (t, J=7.69 Hz, 1H), 7.73 (d, J=8.06 Hz, 2H), 7.90 (dd, J=14.65, 7.57 Hz, 2H), 8.15 (m, 1H), 8.23 (d, J=8.30 Hz, 2H), 8.39 (s, 1H), 10.10 (s, 1H).

The following intermediates were prepared from the appropriate aryl halide/triflate and aryl boronic acid/boronate ester according to the procedure described for intermediate I-X-17, with any significant deviation noted below table.

TABLE O Compounds of Formula X from Suzuki cross-coupling similar to that described in I-X-17 Ex Structure/Name Characterization Data Comments I-X-18 Note 1 Used IV-30 and (4- fluoro-3-formyl- phenyl)boronic acid, (140° C./40 min). I-X-19 Note 2 Used IV-30 and 2- fluoro-3-formyl- phenyl boronic acid. Note 5. I-X-20 Note 3 Used IV-31 and 3- formylphenyl boronic acid. (140° C./1 h) I-X-21 Note 4 Used IV-32 and 3- formylphenyl boronic acid. (140° C./40 min). Note 1 (I-X-18) 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.20 (s, 9H), 6.09 (s, 2H), 7.25-7.31 (m, 1H), 7.66 (d, J = 8.08 Hzs, 2H), 7.87 (m, 1H), 8.13 (dd, J = 6.47, 2.32 Hz, 1H), 8.21 (d, J = 8.30 Hz, 2H), 8.38 (s, 1H), 10.43 (s, 1H). Note 2 (I-X-19) 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.20 (s, 9H), 6.10 (s, 2H), 7.35 (t, J = 7.69 Hz, 1H), 7.65 (d, J = 7.32 Hz, 2H), 7.74 (t, J = 6.84 Hz, 1H), 7.83-7.93 (m, 1H), 8.23 (d, J = 8.30 Hz, 2H), 8.39 (s, 1H), 10.46 (s, 1H). Note 3 (I-X-20) 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.20 (s, 9H), 2.33 (s, 3H), 6.10 (s, 2H), 7.32 (d, J = 8.06 Hz, 1H), 7.56-7.66 (m, 2H), 7.82-7.92 (m, 2H), 8.01 (d, J = 8.06 Hz, 1H), 8.07 (s, 1H), 8.38 (s, 1H), 10.07 (s, 1H). Note 4 (I-X-21) 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ 1.20 (s, 9H), 6.09 (s, 2H), 7.56 (t, J = 7.93 Hz, 1H), 7.63 (t, J = 7.69 Hz, 1H), 7.85-7.98 (m, 3H), 8.01 (d, J = 8.06 Hz, 1H), 8.10 (s, 1H), 8.39 (s, 1H), 10.09 (s, 1H). Note 5 100° C./10 min, then 120° C./20 min. Additional boronic acid and catalyst were added, and heating resumed; 120° C./20 min, then 135° C./30 min.

Intermediate I-X-22 1,1-dimethylethyl [(3′-amino-3,5-difluoro-4-biphenylyl)-methyl]2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-ylcarbamate

Step 1: N-[(3,5-difluoro-3′-nitro-4-biphenylyl)methyl]-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine

A mixture of {4-[(2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-ylamino)methyl]-3,5-difluoro-phenyl}boronic acid (740 mg, 2.44 mmol; Ex V-22), 3-bromonitrobenzene (495 mg, 2.44 mmol), PdCl2(dppf)2 (100 mg, 0.12 mmol) and Na2CO3 (4.90 mL, 2.0 M (aq)) in DME (10 mL) was stirred at 80° C. for 45 min. The mixture was diluted with EtOAc then filtered through a pad of Celite and silica gel. The filtrate was washed with H2O and brine, dried over Na2SO4 then concentrated to give N-[(3,5-difluoro-3′-nitro-4-biphenylyl)methyl]-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine as a tan glass. LC/MS (method A) 0.62 min, (m/z) 381 (70%), 382 (100%).

Step 2: 1,1-dimethylethyl [(3′-amino-3,5-difluoro-4-biphenylyl)methyl]2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-ylcarbamate

A solution of N-[(3,5-difluoro-3′-nitro-4-biphenylyl)methyl]-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine (920 mg, 2.42 mmol; step 1), (Boc)2O (630 mg, 2.90 mmol), and triethylamine (1.70 mL, 12.1 mmol) in THF (10 mL) was stirred at room temperature for 16 hr. The solution was diluted with EtOAc, washed with H2O and brine, dried over Na2SO4 then concentrated. To the residue was added THF (10 mL) and Pd/C (100 mg) and the mixture stirred vigorously at room temperature under 1 atm H2 for 45 min. The mixture was filtered through a pad of Celite and silica gel then concentrated to give 1,1-dimethylethyl [(3′-amino-3,5-difluoro-4-biphenylyl)methyl]2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-ylcarbamate as a tan glass. LC/MS (method A) 1.02 min, (m/z) 451 (M+1).

Compounds of Formula X Example X-1 ethyl 4-[5-({[2-(3-fluorophenyl)ethyl]amino}methyl)-2-furanyl]-benzoate

To a 100 mL round bottom flask was added ethyl 4-(5-formyl-2-furanyl)benzoate (100 mg, 0.41 mmol, commercially available), [2-(3-fluorophenyl)ethyl]amine (0.070 mL, 0.49 mmol), NaBH(OAc)3 (261 mg, 1.23 mmol) and DCE (10 mL). The reaction was stirred at room temperature overnight, quenched with H2O, and extracted with CH2Cl2 (×3). The organic layer was washed with brine, dried with MgSO4 and concentrated under reduced pressure to give 150 mg of ethyl 4-[5-({[2-(3-fluorophenyl)-ethyl]amino}methyl)-2-furanyl]benzoate (used without further purification). LC/MS (method A) 1.97 min; m/z 368 (M+H).

The following examples were prepared from ethyl 4-(5-formyl-2-furanyl)benzoate and the appropriate compounds of Formula III according to the procedure described in Ex X-1, with any significant deviations noted below table.

TABLE P Compounds of Formula X from reductive alkylation of Intermediates of Formula X Ex Structure/Name Characterization Data Comments X-2 LC/MS (method B) 1.95 min, m/z 316.

Example X-3 (3-{3′-[(2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-ylamino)methyl]-4-biphenylyl}-1H-1,2,4-triazol-1-yl)methyl 2,2-dimethylpropanoate

To a solution of [3-(3′-formyl-4-biphenylyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazol-1-yl]methyl 2,2-dimethylpropanoate (0.081 g, 0.22 mmol; I-X-17) and 2-aminoindane (0.045 mL, 0.35 mmol) in 1:1 THF/MeOH (2 mL) was added acetic acid (0.12 mL) and MP—BH3CN (ca. 0.67 mmol, Note 1). The mixture was stirred at room temperature overnight, resin was remove by filtration (THF wash) and the filtrate was concentrated in vacuo. The residue was partitioned between EtOAc/5% Na2CO3, layers were separated and the aqueous layer was extracted with EtOAc. Combined organics were washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4, and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (MeOH/CH2Cl2), affording the title compound. 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.20 (s, 9H), 2.84 (dd, J=15.6, 6.4 Hz, 2H), 3.20 (dd, J=15.6, 7.1 Hz, 2H), 3.68-3.75 (m, 1H), 3.93 (s, 2H), 6.09 (s, 2H), 7.08-7.23 (m, 4H), 7.31-7.38 (m, 1H), 7.41 (t, J=7.6 Hz, 1H), 7.53 (d, J=7.6 Hz, 1H), 7.63 (s, 1H), 7.69 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 2H), 8.19 (d, J=8.3 Hz, 2H), 8.37 (s, 1H).

  • Note 1 ‘MP—BH3CN’=macroporous polymer-supported trialkylammonium cyanoborohydride (Argonaut Technologies).

The following examples were prepared from the appropriate intermediates of formula X and compounds of Formula III according to the procedure described in Ex X-3, with any significant deviations noted below table.

TABLE Q Compounds of Formula X from reductive alkylation of Intermediates of Formula X having an N-protected heterocycle Ex Structure/Name Characterization Data Comments X-4  1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.19 (s, 9H), 2.84 (dd, J = 15.38, 6.35 Hz, 2H), 3.20 (dd, J = 15.63, 7.08 Hz, 2H), 3.66-3.75 (m, 1H), 3.97 (s, 2H), 6.08 (s, 2H), 7.06-7.23 (m, 5H), 7.45-7.53 (m, 1H), 7.62-7.64 (d + m, 3H), 8.17 (d, J = 8.30 Hz, 2H), 8.37 (s, 1H) Used I-X-18 X-5  1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.19 (s, 9H), 2.83 (dd, J = 15.50, 6.47 Hz, 2H), 3.20 (dd, J = 15.50, 6.96 Hz, 2H), 3.67-3.73 (m, 1H), 3.98 (s, 2H), 6.09 (s, 2H), 7.08-7.22 (m, 5H), 7.37 (t, J = 7.32 Hz, 2H), 7.63 (d, J = 7.08 Hz, 2H), 8.19 (d, J = 8.30 Hz, 2H), 8.37 (s, 1H) Used I-X-19 X-6  1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.19 (s, 9H), 2.33 (s, 3H), 2.82 (dd, J = 15.50, 6.47 Hz, 2H), 3.18 (dd, J = 15.38, 7.08 Hz, 2H), 3.67-3.74 (m, 1H), 3.91 (s, 2H), 6.09 (s, 2H), 7.08-7.23 (m, 5H), 7.28-7.41 (m, 4H), 7.97 (d, J = 7.81 Hz, 1H), 8.03 (s, 1H), 8.37 (s, 1H) Used I-X-20 X-7  (M + 1) 489.3 AP, 2.27 min (LC/MS Method B) Used I-X-20 and III-1. Note 1 X-8  (M + 1) 489.3 AP, 2.34 min (LC/MS Method B) Used I-X-20 and III-7. Note 1 X-9  1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.20 (s, 9H), 2.83 (dd, J = 15.50, 6.47 Hz, 2H), 3.19 (dd, J = 15.63, 7.08 Hz, 2H), 3.68-3.75 (m, 1H), 3.93 (s, 2H), 6.09 (s, 2H), 7.09-7.22 (m, 4H), 7.34-7.45 (m, 2H), 7.45-7.60 (m, 3H), 7.88-7.93 (m, 1H), 7.96 (d, J = 8.06 Hz, 1H), 8.38 (s, 1H) Used I-X-21. X-10 (M + 1) 493.3 AP, 2.31 min (LC/MS Method B) Used I-X-21 and III-1. Note 1 X-11 (M + 1) 493.3 AP, 2.34 min (LC/MS Method B) Used I-X-21 and III-7. Note 1 X-12 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.20 (s, 9H), 2.83 (dd, J = 15.50, 6.23 Hz, 2H), 3.19 (dd, J = 15.63, 7.08 Hz, 2H), 3.66-3.72 (m, 1H), 3.98 (s, 2H), 6.09 (s, 2H), 7.08-7.23 (m, 5H), 7.32 (t, J = 6.84 Hz, 1H), 7.38-7.51 (m, 2H), 7.92 (dd, J = 10.99, 1.22 Hz, 1H), 7.97 (d, J = 8.06 Hz, 1H), 8.38 (s, 1H) Impurity present in NMR - material used in the next reaction without further purification. Used I-X-11. Note 3 X-13 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 0.89 (s, 3H), 0.90 (s, 3H), 1.12-1.26 (s + m, 11H), 1.27-1.45 (m, 4H), 1.71-1.80 (m, 2H), 2.41-2.52 (m, 1H), 3.88 (s, 2H), 6.09 (s, 2H), 7.32 (d, J = 7.32 Hz, 1H), 7.40 (t, J = 7.57 Hz, 1H), 7.52 (d, J = 7.57 Hz, 1H), 7.58 (s, 1H), 7.69 (d, J = 8.30 Hz, 2H), 8.18 (d, J = 8.06 Hz, 2H), 8.37 (s, 1H) Used I-X-17 and III-1. Note 1 X-14 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 0.89 (s, 3H), 0.90 (s, 3H), 1.08-1.26 (s + m, 11H), 1.26-1.45 (m, 4H), 1.67-1.81 (m, 2H), 2.38-2.50 (m, 1H), 3.92 (s, 2H), 6.09 (s, 2H), 7.17 (t, J = 7.57 Hz, 1H), 7.28-7.41 (m, 2H), 7.63 (d, J = 8.06 Hz, 2H), 8.19 (d, J = 8.30 Hz, 2H), 8.37 (s, 1H) Used I-X-19 and III-1. Note 1 X-15 (M + 1) 493.2 AP, 0.75 min (LC/MS Method B, gradient time = 1.5 min) Used I-X-19 and III-7. Note 1 X-16 Not characterized (Note 2) Used I-X-11 and III-1. Note 1, 2 X-17 (M + 1) 513.3 AP, 0.71 min (LC/MS Method B, gradient time = 1.5 min) Used I-X-12 and III-1. Note 3 X-18 Not characterized (Note 2) Used I-X-12 and III-1. Note 2 X-19 (M + 1) 517.2 AP, 0.69 min (LC/MS Method B, gradient time = 1.5 min) Used I-X-13. X-20 Not characterized (Note 2) Used I-X-13 and III-1. Note 1, 2 X-21 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 1.19 (s, 9H), 2.82 (dd, J = 15.63, 6.35 Hz, 2H), 3.18 (dd, J = 15.50, 6.96 Hz, 2H), 3.62-3.69 (m, 1H), 4.03 (s, 2H), 6.08 (s, 2H), 6.97 (t, J = 8.55 Hz, 1H), 7.09-7.16 (m, 2H), 7.16-7.23 (m, 2H), 7.35-7.43 (m, 1H), 7.49-7.59 (m, 2H), 8.13 (d, J = 7.08 Hz, 1H), 8.26 (s, 1H), 8.37 (s, 1H) Used I-X-14. X-22 1H NMR (400 MHz, CDCl3) δ ppm 0.89 (s + s, 6H), 1.12-1.27 (s + m, 11H), 1.27-1.45 (m, 4H), 1.69-1.81 (m, 2H), 2.34-2.45 (m, 1H), 3.97 (s, 2H), 6.08 (s, 2H), 6.95 (t, J = 8.55 Hz, 1H), 7.33-7.42 (m, 1H), 7.48-7.60 (m, 2H), 8.12 (d, J = 7.32 Hz, 1H), 8.25 (s, 1H), 8.37 (s, 1H) Used I-X-14 and III-1. Note 1, 4 X-23 Not characterized (Note 2) Used I-X-14 and III-7. Note 1, 2, 4 X-24 (M + 1) 499.2 AP, 0.80 min (LC/MS Method B, gradient time = 1.5 min)) Used I-X-15. Note 4 X-25 (M + 1) 499.2 AP, 0.82 min (LC/MS Method B, gradient time = 1.5 min) Used I-X-16. Note 4 X-26 Not characterized (Note 2) Used I-X-1 and III-3 Note 1, 2 X-27 Not characterized (Note 2) Used I-X-1 Note 1, 2 X-28 LC/MS (method A) 2.25 min; m/z 475 (M + H) Used I-X-3 and III-1 Note 1 X-29 LC/MS (method A) 2.11 min; m/z 482 (M + H) Used I-X-3 Note 1 X-30 Not characterized (Note 2) Used I-X-6 Note 1, 2, 5 X-31 Not characterized (Note 2) Used I-X-7 Note 1, 2, 5 X-32 Note 5 Used I-X-8 Note 1, 5 X-33 Note 6 Used I-X-9 Note 1, 2, 5, 6 X-34 LC/MS (method E) 0.79 min; m/z 499 (M + H) Used I-X-2 and (S)-III-11 Note 1, 7 X-35 LC/MS (method E) 0.79 min; m/z 499 (M + H) Used I-X-2 and (R)-III-11 Note 1, 7 X-36 LC/MS (method E) 0.85 min; m/z 511 (M + H) Used I-X-9 and III-1 Note 1, 8 X-37 LC/MS (method E) 0.84 min; m/z 535 (M + H) Used I-X-9 and (R)-III-11 Note 1, 8 X-38 LC/MS (method E) 0.84 min; m/z 535 (M + H) Used I-X-9 and (S)-III-11 Note 1, 8 X-39 LC/MS (method E) 1.05 min; m/z 547 (M + H) Used I-X-9 and III-8 Note 1, 8 X-40 LC/MS (method E) 0.87 min; m/z 511 (M + H) Used I-X-9 and III-7 Note 1, 8 X-41 LC/MS (method E) 0.82 min; m/z 491 (M + H) Used I-X-9 Note 8 X-42 LC/MS (method E) 83 min; m/z 505 (M + H) Used I-X-9 Note 8 X-43 LC/MS (method E) 0.84 min; m/z 519 (M + H) Used I-X-9 Note 8 X-44 LC/MS (method E) 0.88 min; m/z 537 (M + H) Used I-X-9 Note 8 Note 1 The amine hydrochloride salt used was admixed with an equimolar amount of Et3N in THF/MeOH before use. Note 2 In some cases, particularly on small-scale preparations, the compound of Formula X shown in the above table was carried onto the deprotection step without characterization (en route to Formula I). Note 3 Title compound was purified by preparative HPLC (C − 18 column, MeCN/water gradient with 0.1% TFA additive). Note 4 Solution phase reductive amination conditions were used: 1.5 equiv ea amine/amine-HCl—Et3N (Note 1) and NaBH(OAc)3, ca. 5% v/v HOAc/CH2Cl2 solvent, room temperature. Formula X product purified by flash chromatography (CH2CO2/MeOH). Note 5 Purified by flash chromatography using amine-functionalized silica gel (Teledyne-Isco # 68-2203-102, EtOAc/hexanes). Note 6 Characterizing data for X-33 is given in the alternate preparation below. Note 7 Title compounds also prepared using solution phase reductive amination conditions: 1.1 equiv ea amine-HCl—Et3N (Note 1) and NaBH3CN, ca. 5% v/v HOAc in MeOH as solvent, room temperature. Formula X product was purified by flash chromatography using amine- functionalized silica gel (Teledyne-Isco # 68-2203-102, EtOAc/hexanes). Note 8 1:1 CH2Cl2/MeOH used as solvent instead of 1:1 THF/MeOH.

Alternate Preparation of X-33 (3-{4′-[(2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-ylamino)-methyl]-3′,5′-difluoro-3-biphenylyl}-1H-1,2,4-triazol-1-yl)methyl 2,2-dimethylpropanoate

A mixture of [3-(3′,5′-difluoro-4′-formyl-3-biphenylyl)-1H-1,2,4-triazol-1-yl]methyl 2,2-dimethylpropanoate (67.6 g; 0.17 mol; I-X-9), 2-aminoindane (22.9 g; 0.17 mol; freebase obtained commercially) and HOAc (0.48 mL; 0.0085 mol, Note 1) in PhH (350 mL) was heated under reflux using a Dean-Stark trap to remove water. After 1.5 h, volatiles were removed in vacuo, the residue was dissolved in CH2Cl2/HOAc (400:25 mL respectively), and NaBH(OAc)3 (43 g; 0.203 mol) was added at room temperature. The mixture was stirred 12 h, and quenched by dropwise addition of water (250 mL). The mixture was stirred 30 min and separated into layers. The organic layer was washed (satd NaHCO3, brine), filtered through a pad of Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was triturated with MeOH (250 mL), the resulting slurry was diluted with water (250 mL) and stirred 30 min at room temperature. Solids were collected by filtration, and washed with water. The cake was air-dried overnight on the filter, affording the title compound as an off-white solid, used without further purification. 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 1.1 (s, 9H), 2.74 (dd, J=15.7, 6.1 Hz, 2H), 3.09 (dd, J=15.8, 7.1 Hz, 2H), 3.54 (quint, J=6.6 Hz, 1H), 3.86 (s, 2H), 6.21 (s, 2H), 7.07-7.13 (m, 2H), 7.15-7.21 (m, 2H), 7.43-7.52 (m, 2H), 7.60 (t, J=7.7 Hz, 1H), 7.81 (ddd, J=7.9, 1.8, 1.1 Hz, 1H), 8.06 (ddd, J=7.8, 1.3, 1.2 Hz, 1H), 8.26 (t, J=1.7 Hz, 1H), 8.82 (s, 1H).

  • Note 1 TsOH.H2O (0.05 equiv) has also been used to catalyse imine formation between I-X-9 and compounds of Formula III as described above, with equivalent efficacy.

General Method 1 for Preparation of Compounds of Formula I Example 1 3′-({2-[(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)amino]ethyl}oxy)-4-biphenylcarboxamide Hydrochloride

A mixture of 3′-[(2-chloroethyl)oxy]-4-biphenylcarboxamide and 3′-[(2-bromoethyl)oxy]-4-biphenylcarboxamide (Example II-1) (0.15 g), 4,4-dimethylcyclohexylamine hydrochloride (0.13 g, 0.8 mmol) (prepared according to J. Med. Chem. 1971, 14, p. 600-614) and triethylamine (0.14 g, 1.35 mmol) in methanol (2 mL) was placed in a microwave at 160° C. until the reaction was complete as monitored by LC/MS. The reaction mixture was poured into ethyl acetate and washed several times with 5% Na2CO3 (aq). Silica gel was added to the organic phase and the mixture was concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by silica gel chromatography. The fractions containing the desired product were combined and concentrated in vacuo. Dissolved the residue in ethanol, added 1.0N HCl in Et2O until acidic, added ethyl ether until turbid and let stand at room temperature. The resulting solid was filtered, washed with ethyl ether and dried to give 3′-({2-[(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)amino]ethyl}oxy)-4-biphenylcarboxamide hydrochloride as an off-white solid. (M+H) 367, 1.83 min. (LC/MS method A)

The following examples were prepared from the appropriate halide of Formula II and the corresponding amine of Formula III according to the procedure described for Example 1 of General Method 1, with any significant deviations being noted below the table.

TABLE 1 Compounds of Formula I Generated from Compounds of Formula II Ex Structure/Name Characterization Data Method/Comments  2 (M + H) 408, tR 1.43 min. (LC/MS method A). Used II-1 mixed halides  3 (M + H) 353, tR 1.64 min. (LC/MS method A). Used II-1 mixed halides  4 (M + H) 395, tR 2.02 min. (LC/MS method A). Used II-1 mixed halides  5 (M + H) 341, tR 1.70 min. (LC/MS method A). Used II-1 mixed halides  6 (M + H) 367, tR 1.75 min. (LC/MS method A). Used II-1 mixed halides and III-3 amine  7 (M + H) 341, tR 1.72 min. (LC/MS method A). Used II-1 mixed halides and III-6 amine  8 (M + H) 395, tR 1.98 min. (LC/MS method A). Used II-1 mixed halides and III-5 amine  9 (M + H) 367, tR 1.75 min. (LC/MS method A). Used II-1 mixed halides  10 (M + H) 367, tR 1.80 min. (LC/MS method B) Used II-1 mixed halides  11 (M + H) 327, tR 1.57 min. (LC/MS method A). Used II-1 mixed halides1)  12 (M + H) 313, tR 1.40 min. (LC/MS method A). Used II-1 mixed halides1)  13 (M + H) 365, tR 1.60 min. (LC/MS method A). Used II-1 mixed halides1)  14 (M + H) 353, tR 1.69 min. (LC/MS method A). Used II-1 mixed halides1)  15 (M + H) 379, tR 1.62 min. (LC/MS method A). Used II-1 mixed halides1)  16 (M + H) 367, tR 1.55 min. (LC/MS method A). Used II-1 mixed halides1,2)  17 (M + H) 381, tR 1.90 min. (LC/MS method A) Used II-2 chloride and III-1 amine  18 (M + H) 373, tR 1.66 min. (LC/MS method B). Used II-2 chloride  19 (M + H) 367, tR 1.77 min. (LC/MS method A) Used II-3 mixed halides and III-1 amine  20 (M + H) 353, tR 1.65 min. (LC/MS method A). Used II-3 mixed halides  21 (M + H) 367, tR 1.75 min. (LC/MS method A). Used II-3 mixed halides and III-3 amine2) Reaction time 6 hr (1.5 hr at 160° C. and 4.5 hr at 150° C.)  22 (M + H) 341, tR 1.71 min. (LC/MS method A). Used II-3 mixed halides2)  23 (M + H) 395, tR 2.03 min. (LC/MS method A). Used II-3 mixed halides and III-5 amine Used CH3CN/ethyl ether to form HCl salt  24 (M + H) 353, tR 1.66 min (LC/MS method A) Used II-3 mixed halides1)  25 (M + H) 367, tR 1.82 min. (LC/MS method B). Used II-3 mixed halides  26 (M + H) 327, tR 1.52 min. (LC/MS method A). Used II-3 mixed halides1)  27 (M + H) 379, tR 1.64 min. (LC/MS method A). Used II-3 mixed halides1)  28 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.59 min, m/z 361 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3): 30 min NaI  29 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.63 min, m/z 375 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3): 90 min, Bu4NI used in lieu of NaI  30 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.51 min, m/z 347 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 45 min NaI  31 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.66 min, m/z 361 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 45 min NaI  32 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.70 min, m/z 381 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 45 min NaI  33 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.53 min, m/z 361 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 45 min NaI  34 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.56 min, m/z 365 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride3.4): 30 min NaI  35 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.59 min, m/z 383 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  36 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.88 min, m/z 423 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  37 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.20 min, m/z 329 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  38 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.65 min, m/z 373 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  39 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.55 min, m/z 341 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  40 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.53 min, m/z 353 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  41 (LC/MS Method A) tR 0.24 min, m/z 356 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  42 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.67 min, m/z 375 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  43 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.37 min, m/z 343 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  44 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.04 min, m/z 327 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  45 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.54 min, m/z 373 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  46 (LC/MS Method A) tR 0.73 min, m/z 342 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  47 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.45 min, m/z 353 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  48 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.47 min, m/z 412 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  49 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.36 min, m/z 313 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  50 (LC/MS Method A) tR 0.83 min, m/z 362 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  51 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.14 min, m/z 315 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  52 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.24 min, m/z 329 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  53 (LC/MS Method A) tR 1.66 min, m/z 373 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  54 (LC/MS Method A) tR 0.85 min, m/z 370 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  55 (LC/MS Method B) tR 1.90 min, m/z 381 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  56 (LC/MS Method B) tR 1.61 min, m/z 351 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  57 (LC/MS Method B) tR 1.93 min, m/z 393 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  58 (LC/MS Method B) tR 1.93 min, m/z 393 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  59 (LC/MS Method B) tR 1.77 min, m/z 391 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  60 (LC/MS Method B) tR 2.82 min, m/z 365 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  61 (LC/MS Method B) tR 2.78 min, m/z 359 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  62 (LC/MS Method B) tR 1.66 min, m/z 377 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  63 (LC/MS Method B) tR 1.34 min, m/z 365 (M + H, freebase) Used II-4 chloride1,3.4): 30 min NaI  64 (M + H) 327, tR 1.61 min. (LC/MS Method A) Used II-5 mixed halide  65 (M + H) 353, tR 1.76 min. (LC/MS Method A). Used II-5 mixed halide  66 (M + H) 379, tR 1.70 min. (LC/MS Method A). Used II-5 mixed halide  67 (M + H) 367, tR 2.42 min. (LC/MS Method A) Used II-6 mixed halide Isolated from the reaction mixture using trituation with Et2O and then proceeded as before to form the HCl salt  68 (M + H) 353, tR 1.92 min. (LC/MS Method A). Used II-6 mixed halide Isolated from the reaction mixture using trituation with Et2O and then proceeded as before to form the HCl salt  69 (M + H) 379, tR 2.48 min. (LC/MS Method A). Used II-6 mixed halide Isolated from the reaction mixture using trituation with Et2O and then proceeded as before to form the HCl salt  70 (M + H) 327, tR 1.78 min. (LC/MS Method A). Used II-6 mixed halide Isolated from the reaction mixture using trituation with Et2O and then proceeded as before to form the HCl salt  71 (M + H) 365, tR 2.20 min. (LC/MS Method A). Used II-6 mixed halide Isolated from the reaction mixture using trituation with Et2O and then proceeded as before to form the HCl salt  72 (M + H) 367, tR 1.73 min. (LC/MS Method A) Used II-7 mixed halide  73 (M + H) 341, tR 1.63 min. (LC/MS Method A). Used II-7 mixed halide  74 (M + H) 367, tR 1.84 min. (LC/MS Method A). Used II-7 mixed halide  75 (M + H) 395, tR 2.03 min. (LC/MS Method B) Used II-8 chloride  76 (M + H) 387, tR 1.78 min. (LC/MS Method A Used II-8 chloride Prepared the HCl salt as before. Converted to free base and purified a second time using reverse phase chromatography. Triturated with dichloromethane as a final purification.  77 (M + H) 371, tR 1.74 min. (LC/MS Method A) Used II-9 mixed halide  78 (M + H) 345, tR 1.63 min. (LC/MS Method A). Used II-9 mixed halide  79 (M + H) 397, tR 1.69 min. (LC/MS Method A). Used II-9 mixed halide  80 (M + H) 345, tR 1.58 min. (LC/MS Method A) Used II-10 mixed halide  81 (M + H) 371, tR 1.72 min. (LC/MS Method A). Used II-10 mixed halide  82 (M + H) 397, tR 1.68 min. (LC/MS Method A). Used II-10 mixed halide  83 (M + H) 341, tR 1.68 min. (LC/MS Method A) Used II-11 mixed halide  84 (M + H) 328, tR 1.43 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-12 chloride Isolated by filtration  85 (M + H) 418, tR 1.43 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-12 chloride Isolated by filtration and then free-based using N,N-diisopropyl ethylamine.  86 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ ppm 0.85 (s, 6H) 1.20 (m, 2H) 1.39-1.60 (m, 4H) 1.83 (m, 2H) 3.02 (m, 1H) 3.39 (br., 2H) 4.30 (m, 2H) 7.10 (d, 2H) 7.62 (s, 1H) 7.79 (d, 2H) 8.22 (s, 1H) 8.41 (s, 1H) 8.60 (br., 2H) 8.95 (s, 1H) 8.99 (s, 1H); (M + H) 368, 1.55 min (LC/MS method A) Used II-13 chloride and III-1 amine1)  87 (M + H) 328, tR 1.28 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-13 chloride Isolated by filtration from the reaction  88 (M + H) 355, tR 1.41 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-13 chloride  89 (M + H) 381, tR 1.37 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-13 chloride  90 (M + H) 355, tR 1.37 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-13 chloride Isolated by filtration from the reaction  91 (M + H) 368, tR 1.23 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-13 chloride Isolated by filtration from the reaction  92 (M + H) 366, tR 1.57 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-13 chloride1)  93 (M + H) 392, tR 1.50 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-13 chloride  94 (M + H) 370, tR 0.75 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-13 chloride  95 (M + H) 356, tR 0.64 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-13 chloride  96 (M + H) 416, tR 1.57 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-13 chloride Isolated and submitted as the free-base after chromatography step  97 (M + H) 418, tR 1.25 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-13 chloride Isolated by filtration from the reaction  98 (M + H) 359, tR 1.61 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-14 chloride1)  99 (M + H) 332, tR 1.50 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-15 chloride1) 100 (M + H) 358, tR 1.65 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-15 chloride1) 101 (M + H) 372, tR 1.73 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-15 chloride and III-1 amine1,2) 102 (M + H) 333, tR 1.51 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-15 chloride1) 103 (M + H) 359, tR 1.68 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-15 chloride1) 104 (M + H) 373, tR 1.74 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-15 chloride and III-1 amine1) 105 (M + H) 372, tR 1.79 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-15 chloride and III-71) 106 (M + H) 344, tR 1.47 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-15 chloride1) 107 (M + H) 335, tR 1.51 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-16 chloride 108 (M + H) 386, tR 1.63 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-16 chloride 109 (M + H) 374, tR 1.80 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-17 chloride and III-1 amine 110 (M + H) 334, tR 1.39 min (LC/MS Method A) Used II-17 chloride 111 (M + H) 360, tR 1.54 min (LC/MS method A) Used II-17 chloride Note 1: In some cases, final compounds prepared by this method required purification. There compounds were purified by RP-HPLC (C18 column, MeCN/H2O gradient with TFA additive), yielding final compounds (as TFA salts). Note 2: Free-based the resulting salt. Note 3: Sometimes a promoter such as NaI, Bu4NI was used to facilitate the reaction. Note 4: Reaction performed by microwave heating (90-100° C., 220 W, with air-cooling) in a septum-sealed tube for 30 min intervals until starting material consumed.

General Method 2 for Preparation of Compounds of Formula I Example 112 4-[5-({[2-(3-fluorophenyl)ethyl]amino}methyl)-2-thienyl]benzamide

To a 5 ml conical vial was added [(5-bromo-2-thienyl)methyl][2-(3-fluorophenyl)ethyl]amine (210 mg, 0.67 mmol, Intermediate V-1), (4-aminocarbonylphenyl) boronic acid (110 mg, 0.67 mmol), PdCl2(PPh3)2 (49 mg, 0.07 mmol), K3PO4 (426 mg, 2.0 mmol) and DME/H2O (3/1, 4 mL). The reaction mixture was placed in a microwave at 100° C. for 30 min. The mixture was filtered through a plug of silica gel and purified by RP-HPLC (C18 column, MeCN/H2O gradient with TFA additive) to yield 23 mg of 4-[5-({[2-(3-fluorophenyl)ethyl]amino}methyl)-2-thienyl]benzamide trifluoroacetate. (M+H) 355, 1.43 min (LC/MS method A).

TABLE 2 Compounds of Formula I from Compounds of Formula V Ex. Structure and Name Characterization Data Method/Comments 113 (M + H) 343, 1.14 min (LC/MS method A) Used Intermediate V-2 and 4- bromobenzamide 114 (M + H) 303, 1.36 min (LC/MS method A) Used Intermediate V-3 and 4- bromobenzamide 115 (M + H) 303, 1.32 min (LC/MS method A) Used Intermediate V-4 and 4- bromobenzamide 116 (M + 1) 343, 1.55 min (LC/MS method A) Used Intermediate V-5 and 4- bromobenzamide 117 (M + 1) 355, 1.44 min (LC/MS method A) Used Intermediate V-6 and 4- bromobenzamide 118 (M + 1) 343, 1.58 min (LC/MS method A) Used Intermediate V-7 and 4- bromobenzamide 119 (M + 1) 343, 1.61 min (LC/MS method A) Used Intermediate V-7 and IV-6 120 (LC/MS Method A) 1.76 min, m/z 351 (M + H, freebase) Used Intermediate V-9 and [3- (aminocarbonyl) phenyl]boronic acid 1) 121 (LC/MS Method A) 1.75 min, m/z 351 (M + 1, freebase) Used Intermediate V-10 and [3- (aminocarbonyl) phenyl]boronic acid 1) 122 LC/MS (method A) 1.77 min; m/z 363(M + H) Used Intermediate V-21 and [3- (aminocarbonyl) phenyl]boronic acid PhMe/EtOH (4:1) as organic cosolvent 1,2) Note 1: Na2CO3 was used as the base in the coupling in place of K3PO4. Note 2: In lieu of the HPLC purification step, chromatography on ISCO amine-functionalized silica column using Hex/EtOAc eluted the compound. This was further subjected to HCl and concentrated to the HCl salt.

General Method 3 for Preparation of Compounds of Formula I Example 123 N-[4′-({2-[(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)amino]ethyl}oxy)-4-biphenylyl]acetamide trifluoroacetate

To a solution of 1,1-dimethylethyl (2-{[4′-(acetylamino)-4-biphenylyl]oxy}ethyl) (4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)carbamate (0.0624 g; 0.13 mmol; Intermediate VI-1) and Et3SiH (0.060 mL; 0.37 mmol; ≧2.5 equiv) in CH2Cl2 (2 mL) at rt was added TFA (1 mL). The mixture was aged 3 h and concentrated to dryness, affording the title compound as a colorless solid (see Note 1). (LC/MS Method A) 1.83 min, m/z 381 (M+H, freebase).

  • Note 1) In some cases, final compounds prepared by this method required purification. These compounds were purified by RP-HPLC (C18 column, MeCN/H2O gradient with TFA additive), yielding final compounds (as TFA salts).

TABLE 3 Compounds of Formula I from Compounds of Formula VI Method/ Ex. Structure and Name Characterization Data Comments 124 Note 2 Used Intermediate VI-2 125 LC/MS (LC/MS Method A) 1.85 min, m/z 415 M − H, freebase). Used Intermediate VI-3 126 (LC/MS Method A) 1.43 min, m/z 390 (M + H, freebase) Used Intermediate VI-4 127 (LC/MS Method A) 1.41 min, m/z 390 (M + 1, freebase) Used Intermediate VI-5 128 (LC/MS Method A) 1.75 min, m/z 381 (M + 1, freebase) Used Intermediate VI-6 129 (LC/MS Method A) 1.87 min, m/z 381 (M + 1) Used Intermediate VI-7 130 Need Data Used Intermediate VI-81) 131 LC/MS (LC/MS Method A) 1.63 min, m/z 337 (M + H, freebase) Used Intermediate VI-9 132 (LC/MS Method A) 1.76 min, m/z 351 (M + H, freebase) Used Intermediate VI-10 133 (LC/MS Method A) 1.64 min, m/z 351 (M + H, freebase) Used Intermediate VI-11 134 (LC/MS Method A) 1.72 min, m/z 351 (M + H, freebase) Used Intermediate VI-12 135 LC/MS (LC/MS Method A) 0.75 min, m/z 406.3 (M + 1, freebase) Used Intermediate VI-13, final compound was free-based, then treated with 1.0M HCl in Et2O 136 LC/MS (LC/MS Method A) 0.76 min, m/z 443.3 (M + 1, freebase) Used Intermediate VI-14, final compound was free-based, then treated with 1.0M HCl in Et2O 137 Note 3 Used Intermediate VI-15 138 LC/MS (method E) 0.67 min; m/z 427(M + H) Used Intermediate VI-18 139 LC/MS (method E) 0.69 min; m/z 441(M + H) Used Intermediate VI-16 140 LC/MS (method E) 0.71 min; m/z 455(M + H) Used Intermediate VI-17 141 LC/MS (method E) 0.75 min; m/z 517(M + H) Used Intermediate VI-19 142 LC/MS (method B) 1.72 min; m/z 364(M + H) Used Intermediate VI-20 Note 1: The title compound was also prepared as described in General Method X (TFA salt) and General Method Y (HCl salt). Note 2: 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 0.91 (s, 6H), 1.2 (app. T, J = 12.5 Hz, 2H), 1.43 (app. D, J = 13.1 Hz, 2H), 1.55 (app. D, J = 12.2 Hz, 2H), 1.88 (app. D, J = 11.1 Hz, 2H), 2.06 (s, 3H), 3.04 (br. s, 1H), 4.27 (br. s, 2H), 7.09 (m, 2H), 7.26 (d, J = 7.2 Hz, 1H), 7.34 (app. T, J = 7.6 Hz, 1H), 7.45 (d, J = 7.9 Hz, 1H), 7.57 (m, 2H), 7.90 (s, 1H), 8.66 (br. s, 1H), 10.03 (s, 1H). (N.B.: missing CH2 signal assumed to be obscured by water peak). Note 3: 1H NMR (400 MHz, DMSO-d6) δ 0.91 (s, 6H), 1.22 (app. t, J = 13.0 Hz, 2H), 1.44 (app. d, J = 13.0 Hz, 2H), 1.55 (app. q, J = 12.4 Hz, 2H), 1.88 (app. d, J = 11.2 Hz, 2H), 3.04 (m, 1H), 4.29 (unresolved t, 2H), 7.13 (m, 2H), 7.65 (app. t, J = 7.8 Hz, 1H), 7.72 (m, 2H), 7.86 (d, J = 7.6 Hz, 1H), 7.99 (d, J = 7.5 Hz, 1H), 8.23 (s, 1H), 8.52-8.84 (br. s, 2H), 9.73 (s, 1H) (N.B.: missing CH2 signal assumed to be obscured by water peak).

General Method 4 for Preparation of Compounds of Formula I Example 143 4′-({2-[(4,4-Dimethylcyclohexyl)amino]ethyl}oxy)-2′-methyl-3-biphenylcarboxamide trifluoroacetate

To a solution of 4′-[(2-aminoethyl)oxy]-2′-methyl-3-biphenylcarboxamide trifluoroacetate (0.105 g; 0.273 mmol; Intermediate VII-1) and 4,4-dimethylcyclohexanone (0.038 g; 0.30 mmol; Intermediate Step 1 of III-1) in MeOH/CH2Cl2/HOAc (3 mL; 1:1 MeOH/CH2Cl2 with 5% HOAc) was added Et3N (0.040 mL; 0.27 mmol), followed by PS—BH3CN (0.32 g; ca. 4.2 mmol/g; ca. 1.35 mmol BH3CN). The mixture was agitated overnight at rt using an orbital shaker, and the resin was removed by filtration. The filtrate was concentrated in vacuo, and the residue was purified by RP-HPLC (C18 column, MeCN/H2O gradient with TFA additive) affording the title compound as a colorless foam. (LC/MS Method C) 2.24 min, m/z 381 (M+1, freebase).

The following were prepared in a manner similar to that described in the above example with notation and comment provided for the particular example below the table.

TABLE 4 Compounds of Formula I from Compounds of Formula VII Ex. Structure and Name Characterization Data Method/Comments 144 (M + H) 381, 1.83 min. (LC/MS method A) Used VII-2 and cyclohexane carboxaldehyde Note 5, 6 145 (M + H) 311, 1.55 min. (LC/MS method A) Used VII-2 Note 5, 6 146 (M + H) 351, 1.49 min. (LC/MS method A) Used VII-3 Note 6, 7 147 LC/MS (method A) 2.02 min; m/z 363 (M + H). Used I-VII-9 (Boc'd) Note 3 and Ex III-1 Step 1 intermed. Note 2 148 LC/MS (method C) 1.87 min, m/z 323 (M + H). Used VII-4 149 LC/MS (method D) 1.93 min, m/z 363 (M + H). Used I-VII-10 and Ex III-1 Step 1 intermed. Note 3 150 LC/MS (method A) 1.8 min; m/z 335 (M + H) Used VII-4 Note 4 151 LC/MS (method A) 2 min; m/z 363 (M + H) Used VII-4 Note 4 152 LC/MS (method A) 1.95 min; m/z 349 (M + H) Used VII-4 Note 4 153 LC/MS (method A) 1.85 min; m/z 343 (M + H) Used VII-4 Purified by flash chromatography, added HCl (4M in dioxane) to column fractions. Note 4 154 LC/MS (method A) 1.91 min; m/z 357 (M + H) Used VII-4 Note 4 155 LC/MS (method A) 2.19 min; m/z 363 (M + H) Used VII-5 and Ex III- 1 Step 1 Intermed. Note 4 156 LC/MS (method A) 2.06 min; m/z 377 (M + H) Used I-VII-5 and Ex III-1 Step 1 intermed. Note 3, 4 157 LC/MS (method A) 2.06 min; m/z 382 (M + H) Used I-VII-6 and Ex III-1 Step 1 intermed. Note 3, 4 158 LC/MS (method A) 1.79 min; m/z 386 (M + H) Used I-VII-7 and Ex III-1 Step 1 intermed. Note 3, 4 159 LC/MS (method E) 0.52 min; m/z 331 (M + H) Used VII-7 Note 4, 8 160 LC/MS (method E) 0.57 min; m/z 399 (M + H) Used VII-7 Note 4, 8 161 LC/MS (method E) 0.57 min; m/z 399 (M + H) Used VII-7 Note 4, 8 162 LC/MS (method E) 0.53 min; m/z 349 (M + H) Used VII-7 Note 4, 7(prior to HCl salt formation, the freebase was chromatographed on silica using EtOAc/MeOH) 163 LC/MS (method E) 0.52 min; m/z 349 (M + H) Used VII-7 Note 6, 7(prior to HCl salt formation, the freebase was chromatographed on silica using EtOAc/MeOH) 164 LC/MS (method E) 0.56 min; m/z 399 (M + H) Used VII-7 Note 4, 7(prior to HCl salt formation, the freebase was chromatographed on silica using EtOAc/MeOH) 165 LC/MS (method B) 2.17 min; m /z 373 (M + H) Used VII-7 and III-1 Step 1 intermed. Note 4 166 LC/MS (method B) 2.06 min; m/z 357 (M + H) Used VII-7 Note 4 167 LC/MS (method B) 2.09 min; m/z 337 (M + H) Used VII-7 Note 4 168 LC/MS (method B) 2.23 min; m/z 351 (M + H) Used VII-7 Note 4 169 LC/MS (method B) 2.17 min; m/z 373 (M + H) Used VII-7 Note 4 Note 1 PS—BH3CN = polymer-supported trialkylammonium cyanoborohydride (novabiochem A30113). Note 2 Prepared using a conventional reducing agent (1.1 equiv NaBH3CN) in THF/MeOH/HOAc (5:2:0.5 respectively). After stirring 3 d, the mixture was concentrated in vacuo, and partitioned between CH2Cl2/1M NaOH. The layers were separated, the aqueous layer was extracted with CH2Cl2 (×2), combined organics were washed (water, brine), dried over Na2SO4 and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes). HCl (ca. 4 equiv of a 4M solution in dioxane) was added to column eluent containing the desired product, affording the title compound as a cream-colored solid. The corresponding TFA salt of the title compound has also been prepared from I-VII-9 without isolation of VII-4 (cf. Note 3). Note 3 The deprotected form of Formula VII was not characterized. The crude TFA salt of VII obtained from acidolysis of a Boc protecting group (TFA/Et3SiH/CH2Cl2) was either admixed with an equimolar amount of Et3N, or subjected to a basic aqueous workup (CHCl3/satd Na2CO3) to obtain crude Formula VII which was used directly for reductive alkylation. Note 4 ‘MP—BH3CN’ (Argonaut Technologies 800407) was used as reducing agent (instead of ‘PS—BH3CN’), and MeOH/THF containing ca. 5% HOAc was used as solvent (instead of MeOH/CH2Cl2/HOAc). Note 5 Some dialkylated product was also produced in this reaction. Note 6 Prepared using the standard reductive alkylation reagent sodium triacetoxyborohydride (1.5-3 eq) and (1-3 eq) of aldehyde to amine (VII-2). Note 7 A base extractive workup was performed and the organics subjected to HCl in Et2O or dioxane and the precipitate filtered to give the title compound as the HCl salt. Note 8 Instead of HPLC purification the crude material was subjected to silica chromatography using EtOAc/MeOH followed by recrystallization from CH2Cl2/Hexane.

General Method 5 for Preparation of Compounds of Formula I Compounds of Formula I Prepared According to General Method 5 Procedures Example 170 3′-({[(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)methyl]amino}methyl)-2-methyl-4-biphenylcarboxamide hydrochloride

A mixture of 3′-formyl-2-methyl-4-biphenylcarboxamide (0.15 g, 0.63 mmol; Ex. IX-23), 4,4-dimethylcyclohexylmethylamine hydrochloride (0.28 g, 1.6 mmol; Ex III-1) and acetic acid (4 drops) in methanol was stirred at room temperature for 30 min. Sodium triacetoxyborohydride (0.34 g, 1.6 mmol) was added in one portion and the mixture was stirred at room temperature for 72 hr. Water (10 mL) was added and the mixture was stirred at room temperature for 2 hr. The mixture was concentrated in vacuo to remove the methanol and the residue was taken up in a mixture of ethyl acetate and 5% Na2CO3 (aq). The aqueous phase was extracted with ethyl acetate. The combined organic phase was washed with brine, silica gel was added and the mixture was concentrated in vacuo.

The residue was purified by flash chromatography (CH2Cl2/MeOH). The freebase product obtained was dissolved in acetonitrile, filtered, and HCl was added (1M in Et2O) until turbid, and allowed to stand at room temperature. Precipitated solid was collected by filtration, washed with (Et2O) and air-dried to give the title compound as a white solid. LC/MS (method A) 1.90 min; m/z 365 (M+H).

Example 171 2: 4′-[(2,3-Dihydro-1H-inden-2-ylamino)methyl]-3-biphenyl-carboxamide trifluoroacetate

To a solution of 4′-formyl-3-biphenylcarboxamide (0.056 g; 0.25 mmol; Ex. IX-1) in MeOH/CH2Cl2/HOAc (5% v/v HOAc in 1:1 MeOH/CH2Cl2, 3 mL) at room temperature was added 2-aminoindane (0.375 mmol; Note 1), followed by PS—BH3CN (0.30 g; see Note 2). The mixture was agitated overnight, resin was removed by filtration and the filtrate was concentrated in vacuo The residue was purified by preparative HPLC (C-18 column, MeCN/H2O gradient with 0.1% TFA additive) affording the final compound as a colorless solid (Note 3). LC/MS (method A) 1.58 min, m/z 343 (M+H, 57%), 210 ([M-aminoindane]+H, 100%).

  • Note 1 2-aminoindane hydrochloride was admixed with an equimolar amount of Et3N in CH2Cl2 before mixing with IX-1.
  • Note 2 ‘PS—BH3CN’=polymer-supported trialkylammonium cyanoborohydride reagent (novabiochem A30113). An excess of PS—BH3CN was used (est. 3-5 equiv BH3CN based on benzaldehyde starting materials).
  • Note 3 The title compound (as HCl salt) was also prepared using solution-phase conditions similar to Example 172 below.

Example 172 4′-{[(4,4-dimethylcyclohexyl)amino]methyl}-3-biphenyl-carboxamide hydrochloride

A mixture of 4′-formyl-3-biphenylcarboxamide (0.576 g; 2.56 mmol; Ex IX-1), 4,4-dimethylcyclohexylamine (0.390 g; 3.07 mmol; Note 1), and TsOH.H2O (0.049 g; 0.26 mmol) in PhH (15 mL) was heated under reflux overnight, using a Dean-Stark trap to remove water. Upon cooling, volatiles were removed in vacuo, the residue was dissolved in 2.5% HOAc in MeOH (20 mL), and NaBH3CN (0.17 g; 2.8 mmol) was added in one portion. The mixture was stirred at room ca. 1 h (Note 2). The mixture was concentrated in vacuo, the residue was partitioned between CH2Cl2/1M NaOH and the layers were separated. The organic layer was washed (H2O, brine), dried over Na2SO4, filtered and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was purified by preparative HPLC(C-18 column, MeCN/H2O gradient with 0.1% TFA additive); eluent containing desired product was poured into EtOAc/satd Na2CO3, layers were separated, the organic layer was washed with brine and dried over Na2SO4. HCl (1 mL of a 4M solution in dioxane) was added to the dried extract and the mixture was concentrated in vacuo, affording the title compound as a colorless solid (Note 3). LC/MS (method A) 2.06 min, m/z 337 (M+H).

  • Note 1 Ex III-1 was freebased before use by partitioning between Et2O and satd Na2CO3, separating layers, drying the organic layer over Na2SO4 and concentrating in vacuo.
  • Note 2 An aliquot of the reaction mixture after 45 min indicated complete conversion.
  • Note 3 The title compound was also prepared as a TFA salt according to General Method 3.

Compounds of Formula I Prepared by General Method 5

The following examples were prepared from the appropriate compounds of Formula IX and III in a manner similar to one of the representative examples given above; any significant deviations are noted below table. Compounds of Formula III which are readily available from commercial sources are not listed in the table.

TABLE 5 Compounds of Formula I from Compounds of Formula IX Ex Structure and Name Characterization Data Comments 173 LC/MS (method A) 1.76 min, m/z 351 (M + H) Used IX-3 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 174 LC/MS (method A) 1.66 min, m/z 337 (M + H) Used IX-1 and III-3 General Method: Example 171 175 LC/MS (method A) 1.57 min, m/z 323 (M + H) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 176 LC/MS (method A) 1.45 min, m/z 335 (M + H) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 177 LC/MS (method A) 1.51 min, m/z 331 (M + H) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 178 LC/MS (method A) 1.72 min, m/z 351 (M + H) Used IX-4 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 179 LC/MS (method C) 2.10 min, m/z 337 (M + H) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 180 LC/MS (method C) 2.09 min, m/z 337 (M + H) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 181 LC/MS (method C) 2.09 min, m/z 361 (M + H) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 182 LC/MS (method C) 2.22 min, m/z 363 (M + H) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 183 LC/MS (method C) 2.11 min, m/z 337 (M + H) Used IX-5 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 184 LC/MS (method C) 2.10 min, m/z 337 (M + H) Used IX-6 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 185 LC/MS (method C) 1.94 min, m/z 297 (M + H) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 186 LC/MS (method C) 1.89 min, m/z 297 (M + H) Used IX-6 General Method: Example 171 187 LC/MS (method A) 1.37 min, m/z 360 (M + H) Used IX-7 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 188 LC/MS (method A) 1.15 min, m/z 366 (M + H) Used IX-7 General Method: Example 171 189 LC/MS (method A) 1.61 min, m/z 357 (M + H) Used IX-4 General Method: Example 171 190 LC/MS (method A) 1.49 min, m/z 311 (M + H) Used IX-4 General Method: Example 171 191 LC/MS (method C) 2.13 min, m/z 367 (M + H) Used IX-8 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 192 LC/MS (method C) 2.17 min, m/z 371 (M + H) Used IX-9 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 193 LC/MS (method C) 1.99 min, m/z 323 (M + H) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 194 LC/MS (method C) 2.18 min, m/z 337 (M + H) Used IX-1 and III-7 General Method: Example 171 195 LC/MS (method D) 2.05 min, m/z 355 (M + H) Used IX-10 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 196 LC/MS (method D) 1.77 min, m/z 345 (M + H) Used IX-1 and 4,4- difluorocyclohexylamine hydrochloride (commercial). General Method: Example 171 197 LC/MS (method D) 1.57 min, m/z 359 (M + H) Used IX-2 and 4,4- difluorocyclohexylamine hydrochloride (commercial). General Method: Example 171 198 LC/MS (method D) 1.87 min, m/z 357 (M + H) Used IX-2 General Method: Example 171 199 LC/MS (method B) 2.16 min, m/z 351 (M + H) Used IX-16 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 200 LC/MS (method B) 2.15 min, m/z 351 (M + H) Used IX-17 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 201 LC/MS (method B) 2.08 min, m/z 355 (M + H) Used IX-12 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 202 LC/MS (method B). 1.63 min, m/z 357 (M + H). Used IX-23 General Method: Example 170 203 LC/MS (method B). 1.82 min, m/z 351 (M + H). Used IX-23 and III-7 General Method: Example 170 204 LC/MS (method B). 1.61 min, m/z 337 (M + H). Used IX-23 General Method: Example 170 205 LC/MS (method A) 1.89 min; m/z 370 Used methyl 4-(5- formyl-2-thienyl)- benzoate (commercial) General Method: Example 170 Used DCE as solvent. 206 LC/MS (method A) 1.81 min; m/z 318 Used methyl 4-(5- formyl-2- thienyl)bezoate (commercial) General Method: Example 170 Used DCE as solvent. 207 LC/MS (method D) 2.08 min, m/z 351 (M + H). Used IX-20 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 208 LC/MS (method D) 2.14 min, m/z 405 (M + H). Used IX-54 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 209 LC/MS (method A) 1.77 min; m/z 360(M + H). Used IX-18 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 210 LC/MS (method A) 1.65 min; m/z 366(M + H). Used IX-18 General Method: Example 171 211 LC/MS (method A) 2.05 min; m/z 361(M + H). Used IX-1 and III-10 General Method: Example 171 212 LC/MS (method A) 2.03 min; m/z 373(M + H). Used IX-1 and III-14 General Method: Example 171 213 LC/MS (method A) 1.99 min; m/z 372(M + H). Used IX-1 and III-13 General Method: Example 171 214 LC/MS (method A) 1.9 min; m/z 403(M + H). Used IX-1 and III-15 General Method: Example 171 215 LC/MS (method A) 2.28 min; m/z 419(M + H). Used IX-56 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 2 216 LC/MS (method B) 2.22 min; m/z 351(M + H). Used IX-11 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 217 LC/MS (method B) 2.14 min; m/z 357(M + H). Used IX-11 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 2 218 LC/MS (method B) 1.99 min; m/z 361(M + H). Used IX-12 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 2 219 LC/MS (method B) 2.33 min; m/z 405(M + H). Used IX-55 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 220 LC/MS (method B) 2.23 min; m/z 411(M + H). Used IX-55 General Method: Note 1 Example 171 221 LC/MS (method B) 2.06 min; m/z 371(M + H). Used IX-13 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 2 Also 170 (Note 3) 222 LC/MS (method B) 1.94 min; m/z 377(M + H). Used IX-13 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 2 223 LC/MS (method A) 2.1 min; m/z 367(M + H). Used IX-14 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 224 LC/MS (method A) 2.01 min; m/z 373(M + H). Used IX-14 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 225 LC/MS (method A) 2.13 min; m/z 355(M + H). Used IX-1 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 2 Also 170 (Note 3) 226 LC/MS (method A) 2.02 min; m/z 361(M + H). Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 2 227 LC/MS (method A) 2.21 min; m/z 373(M + H). Used IX-47 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 228 LC/MS (method A) 2.15 min; m/z 391(M + H). Used IX-46 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 229 LC/MS (method A) 2.1 min; m/z 377(M + H). Used IX-44 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 230 LC/MS (method B) 2.05 min; m/z 361(M + H). Used IX-1 and (S)-III-11 General Method: Example 170 Note 4 231 LC/MS (method B) 2.01 min; m/z 361(M + H). Used IX-1 and (R)-III-11 General Method: Example 170 Note 4 232 LC/MS (method A) 2.01 min; m/z 379(M + H). Used IX-1 and III-9 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 233 LC/MS (method A) 1.84 min; m/z 368(M + H). Used IX-1 and III-12 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 2 234 LC/MS (method A) 2.01 min; m/z 357(M + H). Used IX-1 and III-16 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 235 LC/MS (method A) 1.88 min; m/z 395(M + H). Used IX-13 and (S)-III-11 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 236 LC/MS (method A) 1.88 min; m/z 395(M + H). Used IX-13 and (R)-III-11 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 237 LC/MS (method A) 2.14 min; m/z 355(M + H). Used IX-48 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 238 LC/MS (method A) 2.24 min; m/z 371(M + H). Used IX-49 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 239 LC /MS (method A) 2.3 min; m/z 405(M + H). Used IX-50 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 240 LC/MS (method A) 1.9 min; m/z 338(M + H). Used IX-45 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 241 LC/MS (method A) 2.04 min; m/z 338(M + H). Used IX-51 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 2 242 LC/MS (method A) 1.95 min; m/z 338(M + H). Used IX-52 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 243 LC/MS (method A) 2.03 min; m/z 389(M + H). Used IX-38 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 244 LC/MS (method A) 2.11 min; m/z 369(M + H). Used IX-53 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 245 LC/MS (method A) 2.13 min; m/z 373(M + H). Used IX-41 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 Also 170 (Note 4) 246 LC/MS (method A) 2.21 min; m/z 373(M + H). Used IX-42 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 247 LC/MS (method A) 2.13 min; m/z 351(M + H). Used IX-43 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 248 LC/MS (method A) 2.21 min; m/z 371 (79%), 373 (100%)(M + H). Used IX-44 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 2 249 LC/MS (method A) 1.9 min; m/z 366(M + H). Used IX-57 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 250 LC/MS (method B) 2 min; m/z 338(M + H). Used IX-40 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 251 LC/MS (method B) 1.9 min; m/z 338(M + H). Used IX-19 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 252 LC/MS (method B) 2.06 min; m/z 361(M + H). Used IX-48 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 253 LC/MS (method B) 2.09 min; m/z 379(M + H). Used IX-42 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 2 254 LC/MS (method B) 1.88 min; m/z 344(M + H). Used IX-40 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 255 LC/MS (method B) 1.77 min; m/z 344(M + H). Used IX-19 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 256 LC/MS (method B) 1.92 min; m/z 395(M + H). Used IX-39 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 257 LC/MS (method A) 1.77 min; m/z 383(M + H). Used IX-21 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 258 LC/MS (method A) 1.62 min; m/z 379(M + H). Used IX-15 and (S)-III-11 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 2 Also 170 (Note 3) 259 LC/MS (method A) 1.62 min; m/z 379(M + H). Used IX-15 and (R)-III-11 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 2 Also 170 (Note 3) 260 LC/MS (method E) 1.02 min; m/z 373(M + H). Used IX-22 and III-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1 261 LC/MS (method E) 0.94 min; m/z 379(M + H). Used IX-22 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 2 262 LC/MS (method E) 0.63 min; m/z 317 (M + 1) Used IX-1 General Method Example 171 Note 1, 4 263 LC/MS (method E) 0.69 min; m/z 385 (M + 1) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 4 264 LC/MS (method E) 0.7 min; m/z 385 (M + 1) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 4 265 LC/MS (method E) 0.61 min; m/z 453 (M + 1) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 4 266 LC/MS (method E) 0.55 min; m/z 385 (M + 1) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 5 267 LC/MS (method E) 0.56 min; m/z 335 (M + 1) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 5 268 LC/MS (method E) 0.63 min; m/z 401 (M + 1) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 5 269 LC/MS (method E) 0.58 min; m/z 351 (M + 1) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 5 270 LC/MS (method E) 0.52 min; m/z 335 (M + 1) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 5 271 LC/MS (method E) 0.59 min; m/zz 401 (M + 1 Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 5 272 LC/MS (method E) 0.54 min; m/z 351 (M + 1) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 5 273 LC/MS (method E) 0.59 min; m/z 385 and 387 (M + 1 Cl isotopes) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 5 274 LC/MS (method E) 0.66 min; m/z 331 (M + 1) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 4 275 LC/MS (method E) 0.49 min; m/z 301 (M + 1) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 5 276 LC/MS (method E) (0.51) min; m/z 315 (M + 1) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 171 Note 1, 5 277 LC/MS (method E) 0.65 min; m/z 343 (M + 1) Used IX-1 General Method: Example 172 Note 6 278 LC/MS (method A) 1.52 min; m/z 377 (M + H). Used IX-24 General Method: Example 170 279 LC/MS (method A) 1.72 min; m/z 371 (M + H). Used IX-24 and III-7 General Method: Example 170 280 LC/MS (method A) 1.71 min; m/z 371 (M + H). Used IX-24 and III-1 General Method: Example 170 281 LC/MS (method B) 1.53 min; m/z 373 (M + H). Used IX-25 General Method: Example 170 282 LC/MS (method A) 1.79 min; m/z 367 (M + H). Used IX-25 and III-7 General Method: Example 170 283 LC/MS (method A) 1.68 min; m/z 367 (M + H). Used IX-25 and III-1 General Method: Example 170 284 LC/MS (method A) 1.65 min; m/z 377 (M + H). Used IX-26 General Method: Example 170 285 LC/MS (method A) 1.88 min; m/z 371 (M + H). Used IX-26 and III-7 General Method: Example 170 286 LC/MS (method B) 1.76 min; m/z 371 (M + H). Used IX-26 and III-1 General Method: Example 170 287 LC/MS (method A) 1.59 min; m/z 361(M + H). Used IX-27 General Method: Example 170 288 LC/MS (method A) 1.80 min; m/z 355 (M + H). Used IX-27 and III-7 General Method: Example 170 289 LC/MS (method A) 1.72 min; m/z 355 (M + H). Used IX-27 and III-1 General Method: Example 170 290 355 1.71 LC/MS (method A) min; m/z (M + H). Used IX-28 and III-7 General Method: Example 170 291 LC/MS (method A) 1.48 min; m/z 361 (M + H). Used IX-28 General Method: Example 170 292 LC/MS (method A) 1.63 min; m/z 355 (M + H). Used IX-28 and III-1 General Method: Example 170 293 LC/MS (method A) 1.75 min; m/z 355 (M + H). Used IX-29 and III-7 General Method: Example 170 294 LC/MS (method A) 1.53 min; m/z 361 (M + H). Used IX-29 General Method: Example 170 295 LC/MS (method A) 1.72 min; m/z 355 (M + H). Used IX-29 and III-1 General Method: Example 170 Note 6 296 LC/MS (method A) 1.89 min; m/z 371 (M + H). Used IX-30 and III-7 General Method: Example 170 297 LC/MS (method A) 1.80 min; m/z 371 (M + H). Used IX-30 and III-1 General Method: Example 170 Note 6 298 LC/MS (method A) 1.69 min; m/z 377 (M + H). Used IX-30 General Method: Example 170 299 LC/MS (method A) 1.80 min; m/z 369 (M + H). Used IX-31 and III-7 General Method: Example 170 300 LC/MS (method A) 1.62 min; m/z 375 (M + H). Used IX-31 General Method: Example 170 301 LC/MS (method A) 1.69 min; m/z 369 (M + H). Used IX-31 and III-1 General Method: Example 170 Note 6 302 LC/MS (method A) 1.74 min; m/z 367 (M + H). Used IX-32 and III-7 General Method: Example 170 303 LC/MS (method A) 1.70 min; m/z 367 (M + H). Used IX-32 and III-1 General Method: Example 170 Note 6 304 LC/MS (method A) 0.69 min, m/z 382 (M + H). Used IX-34 General Method: Example 170 Note 7 305 LC/MS (method A) 0.66 min, m/z 383 (M + H). Used IX-35 General Method: Example 170 Note 7 306 LC/MS (method A) 0.66 min, m/z 398 (M + H). Used IX-36 General Method: Example 170 Note 7 307 LC/MS (method A) 0.71 min, m/z 338 (M + H). Used IX-37 General Method: Example 170 Note 7 308 LC/MS (method A) 0.58 min, m/z 420 (M + H). Used IX-38 General Method: Example 170 Note 7 309 LC/MS (method A) 0.61 min, m/z 414 (M + H). Used IX-38 and III-1 General Method: Example 170 Note 7 310 LC/MS (method A) 0.74 min, m/z 378 (M + H). Used IX-37 and III-1 General Method: Example 170 Note 7 Note 1 ‘MP—BH3CN’ polymer-supported cyanoborohydride (Argonaut Technologies p/n 800407) was used as reducing agent (ca. 3 equiv BH3CN), THF/MeOH/HOAc mixture (ca. 5% HOAc in 1:1 THF/MeOH) was used as solvent. Note 2 Product was purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes) using amine-functionalized silica gel (Teledyne-Isco p/n 68-2203-102). HCl solution (4M in dioxane) was added to column eluent containing the desired product and the whole was concentrated in vacuo, affording an HCl salt. Note 3 NaBH3CN (1.2 equiv) was used as reducing agent, and THF/MeOH/HOAc (ca. 5% HOAc in 1:1 THF/MeOH) was used as solvent. Note 4 Title compounds were obtained as freebases from the crude reaction filtrates, after concentration, by triturating with CH2Cl2, and drying in vacuo at 60° C. overnight. Note 5 In those cases where the reaction products could not be resolved from impurities by chromatography, the crude residues were subjected to standard N-Boc protection conditions (Boc2O/Et3N/CH2Cl2). The resulting carbamate was then purified by flash chromatography (EtOAc/hexanes), dissolved in CH2Cl2 and treated with HCl in dioxane, effecting deprotection and affording the title compound as an HCl salt. Note 6 Amine hydrochloride salt used was admixed with Et3N before use. Note 7 Crude residues obtained after aqueous workup (Na2CO3/EtOAc) were taken up in dioxane and treated with HCl in Et2O. Supernatant liquid was decanted away, and the precipitated solids were air-dried, affording the title compounds as HCl salts.

General Method 6 for Preparation of Compounds of Formula I General Method 6 Preparation of 2,5-Substituted Furans Example 311 Preparation of 4-[5-({[2-(3-fluorophenyl)ethyl]amino}methyl)-2-furanyl]benzamide

To a 50 mL sealed tube was added ethyl 4-[5-({[2-(3-fluorophenyl)ethyl]amino}methyl)-2-furanyl]benzoate (100 mg, 0.27 mmol, Example X-1), 2.0 M MeOH/NH3 (20 mL), and KCN (30 mg). The reaction mixture was stirred at 125° C. overnight. The crude mixture was purified on RP-preparative HPLC to give 3 mg of 4-[5-({[2-(3-fluorophenyl)ethyl]amino}methyl)-2-furanyl]benzamide. (M+1) 339.23, 1.42 min (LC/MS method A)

The following were prepared in a manner similar to that described in General Method 6 Example using the corresponding amine

TABLE 6 Compounds of Formula I from Compounds of Formula X via Aminolysis Ex. Structure and Name Characterization Data Method/Comments 312 (M + H) 287, 1.24 min (LC/MS method A) Used Example X-2

General Method 7 Deprotection of Compounds of Formula X to Compounds of Formula I Example 313 N-{[4′-(1H-1,2,4-triazol-3-yl)-3-biphenylyl]methyl}-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine hydrochloride

To a solution of (3-{3′-[(2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-ylamino)methyl]-4-biphenylyl}-1H-1,2,4-triazol-1-yl)methyl 2,2-dimethylpropanoate (0.084 g, 0.17 mmol, Example X-3) in EtOH (1.5 mL) was added a 4.37 M solution of NaOMe in MeOH (0.08 mL, 0.35 mmol). The mixture was stirred for 50 min at RT. A 1.2M solution of concentrated HCl in EtOH was added (1.2 mL), and the mixture was heated at 80° C. for 1 h. The reaction mixture was cooled, diluted with water, and basified to a pH of 10 with addition of saturated Na2CO3 (aq). The mixture was extracted with EtOAc. The combined organic extracts were washed with water and brine, dried with anhydrous Na2SO4, and concentrated in vacuo. The residue was dissolved in CH2Cl2 and MeOH, and 4N HCl in dioxane was added (0.2 mL). After stirring for 15 min, the precipitate was filtered, washed with CH2Cl2, and dried, affording the title compound as a colorless solid (0.057 g, 89%). (M+H) 367, 1.74 min (LC/MS Method B).

TABLE 7 Compounds of Formula I from Compounds of Formula X via N-deprotection Ex. Structure and Name Characterization Data Method/Comments 314 (M + H) 385, 1.79 min (LC/MS Method B) Synthesized from X-4. 315 (M + H) 385, 1.74 min (LC/MS Method B) Synthesized from X-5. 316 (M + H) 381, 1.77 min (LC/MS Method B) Synthesized from X-6. Eliminated MeOH for salt formation. 317 (M + H) 375, 0.60 min (LC/MS Method F) Synthesized from X-7. 318 (M + H) 375, 0.62 min (LC/MS Method F) Synthesized from X-8. 319 (M + H) 385, 1.78 min (LC/MS Method B) Synthesized from X-9. 320 (M + H) 379, 0.61 min (LC/MS Method F) Synthesized from X-10. 321 (M + H) 379, 0.61 min (LC/MS Method F) Synthesized from X-11. Eliminated MeOH for salt formation. 322 (M + H) 403, 0.56 min (LC/MS Method F) Synthesized from X-12. 323 (M + H) 361, 0.59 min (LC/MS Method F) Synthesized from X-13. 324 (M + H) 379, 0.58 min (LC/MS Method F) Synthesized from X-14. Eliminated MeOH for salt formation. 325 (M + H) 379, 0.60 min (LC/MS Method F) Synthesized from X-15. Eliminated MeOH for salt formation. 326 (M + H) 397, 0.59 min (LC/MS Method F) Synthesized from X-16. Eliminated MeOH for salt formation. 327 (M + H) 399, 0.56 min (LC/MS Method F) Synthesized from X-17. Eliminated MeOH for salt formation. 328 (M + H) 393, 0.59 min (LC/MS Method F) Synthesized from X-18. Eliminated MeOH for salt formation. 329 (M + H) 403, 0.56 min (LC/MS Method F) Synthesized from X-19. Eliminated MeOH for salt formation. 330 (M + H) 397, 0.60 min (LC/MS Method F) Synthesized from X-20. Eliminated MeOH for salt formation. 331 (M + H) 403, 0.71 min (LC/MS Method F) Synthesized from X-21. Eliminated MeOH for salt formation. 332 (M + H) 397, 0.76 min (LC/MS Method F) Synthesized from X-23. Eliminated MeOH for salt formation. 333 (M + H) 385, 0.70 min (LC/MS Method F) Synthesized from X-24. 334 (M + H) 385, 1.81 min (LC/MS Method A) Synthesized from X-25. Eliminated MeOH for salt formation. 335 (LC/MS method B) 2.26 min; m/z 361 (M + H) Synthesized from X-26 336 (LC/MS method B) 2.17 min; m/z 367 (M + H) Synthesized from X-27 337 (LC/MS method A) 2.31 min; m/z 361 (M + H) Synthesized from X-28 338 (LC/MS method A) 2.21 min; m/z 367 (M + H) Synthesized from X-29 339 (LC/MS method A) 1.66 min; m/z 386 (M + H) Synthesized from X-30 340 (LC/MS method A) 1.61 min; m/z 399 (100%), 400 (21%), 402 (37%) (M + H) Synthesized from X-31 341 (LC/MS method A) 1.76 min; m/z 385 (M + H) Synthesized from X-32 342 0.71 min; m/z 403 (M + H) Synthesized from X-33 Note 2 343 (LC/MS method A) 1.76 min; m/z 385 (M + H) Synthesized from X-34 344 (LC/MS method A) 1.74 min; m/z 385 (M + H) Synthesized from X-35 345 (LC/MS method E) 0.59 min; m/z 397 (M + H) Synthesized from X-36 346 (LC/MS method E) 0.72 min; m/z 421 (M + H) Synthesized from X-37 347 (LC/MS method E) 0.56 min; m/z 421 (M + H) Synthesized from X-38 348 (LC/MS method E) 0.85 min; m/z 433 (M + H) Synthesized from X-39 349 (LC/MS method E) 0.6 min; m/z 397 (M + H) Synthesized from X-40 350 (LC/MS method E) 0.54 min; m/z 377 (M + H) Synthesized from X-41 351 (LC/MS method E) 0.71 min; m/z 391 (M + H) Synthesized from X-42 352 (LC/MS method E) 0.57 min; m/z 405 (M + H) Synthesized from X-43 353 (LC/MS method E) 0.62 min; m/z 423 (M + H) Synthesized from X-44 Note 1: Purified by reverse phase chromatography (CH3CN/H2O/TFA). Note 2: The crude product can also be isolated as diHCl salt straight from the reaction after one hour of stirring. Then recrystallized from EtOH/HCl(aq).

LC/MS Method A (Standard Electrospry Method):

Mass Spectrometry is used to confirm peak identity with electrospray+/−ionization scanning from 100-1000 m/z and DAD from 220-400 nm. Phenomenex Luna column 4.6 mm by 2 cm, particle size 3 um, ambient temperature. Solvent flow at 2 ml/min. Gradient begins at 10% MeOH and goes linearly to 100% MeOH in 3 minutes, holds 100% MeOH for 1 minute, making total chromatogram time 4 minutes. 2 ul sample injection. Aqueous mobile phase contains 0.1% v/v Formic Acid and MeOH contains 0.075% v/v Formic Acid.

LC/MS Method B (Standard APCI Method):

Mass Spectrometry is used to confirm peak identity with APCI+/−ionization scanning from 100-1000 m/z and DAD from 220-400 nm. Phenomenex Luna column 4.6 mm by 2 cm, particle size 3 um, ambient temperature. Solvent flow at 2 ml/min. Gradient begins at 10% MeOH and goes linearly to 100% MeOH in 3 minutes, holds 100% MeOH for 1 minute, making total chromatogram time 4 minutes. 2 ul sample injection. Aqueous mobile phase contains 0.1% v/v Formic Acid and MeOH contains 0.075% v/v Formic Acid.

LC/MS Method C (Polar APCI Method):

Mass Spectrometry is used to confirm peak identity with APCI+/−ionization scanning from 100-1000 m/z and DAD from 220-400 nm. Phenomenex Luna column 4.6 mm by 2 cm, particle size 3 um, ambient temperature. Solvent flow at 2 ml/min. Gradient begins at 2% MeOH and goes linearly to 26% MeOH in 1 minute, then goes linearly from 26% MeOH to 100% MeOH in 2 min., then holds 100% MeOH for 1 minute, making total chromatogram time 4 minutes. 2 ul sample injection. Aqueous mobile phase contains 0.1% v/v Formic Acid and MeOH contains 0.075% v/v Formic Acid.

LC/MS Method D (Polar Electrospray Method):

Mass Spectrometry is used to confirm peak identity with electrospray+/−ionization scanning from 100-1000 m/z and DAD from 220-400 nm. Phenomenex Luna column 4.6 mm by 2 cm, particle size 3 um, ambient temperature. Solvent flow at 2 ml/min. Gradient begins at 2% MeOH and goes linearly to 26% MeOH in 1 minute, then goes linearly from 26% MeOH to 100% MeOH in 2 min., then holds 100% MeOH for 1 minute, making total chromatogram time 4 minutes. 2 ul sample injection. Aqueous mobile phase contains 0.1% v/v Formic Acid and MeOH contains 0.075% v/v Formic Acid.

LC-MS Method E (Standard Electrospray Fast Mass Spec Method):

Electrospray+ionization scanning from 100-800 m/z with DAD sum from 220-400 nm. Waters Acquity UPLC column 2.1 mm by 5 cm, particle size 1.7 um, temperature at 40 degrees C. Solvent flow at 1 ml/min. Gradient begins at 6% ACN and goes linearly to 70% ACN in 0.57 minute; gradient then goes linearly to 99% ACN from 0.57 minute to 1.06 minute, holds 99% ACN until 1.5 minute, making total chromatogram time 1.5 minutes. 1.5 ul sample injection. Aqueous mobile phase contains 0.1% v/v Formic Acid and ACN contains trace v/v Formic Acid.

LC-MS Method F (Standard APCI Fast Mass Spec Method):

Mass Spectrometry is used to confirm peak identity with APCI+/−ionization scanning from 100-1000 m/z and DAD from 220-400 nm. Column is Waters Acquity BEH UPLC column 2.1 mm by 5 cm, particle size 1.7 um, temperature at 25 degrees C. Solvent flow at 1 ml/min. Gradient begins at 6% ACN and goes linearly to 70% ACN in 0.57 minute; gradient then goes linearly to 99% ACN from 0.57 minute to 1.06 minute, holds 99% ACN until 1.5 minute, making total chromatogram time 1.5 minutes. 1.5 ul sample injection. Aqueous mobile phase contains 0.1% v/v Formic Acid and ACN contains trace v/v Formic Acid.

ABBREVIATIONS

anhyd anhydrous
APCI atmospheric pressure chemical ionization
app. apparent
BH3.DMS borane-dimethyl sulfide complex
(Boc)2O di-tert-butyl dicarbonate
BOC tert-Butoxycarbonyl
br. broad
ca. approximately
cf. compare to
conc concentrated
Cbz benzyloxycarbonyl
DCE dichloroethane
DIBAL-H diisobutylaluminum hydride
DIPEA diisopropylethylamine
DMAP 4-dimethylaminopyridine
DME 1,2-dimethoxyethane
DMF dimethylformamide
DMSO dimethylsulfoxide
dppf 1,1′-Bis(diphenylphosphino)ferrocene
ESI electrospray ionization
Et2O diethyl ether
Et3N triethylamine
Et3SiH triethylsilane
EtOAc ethyl acetate
EtOH ethanol
h hour
HOAc acetic acid
in vacuo under reduced pressure
KOAc potassium acetate
LC/MS liquid chromatography-mass spectrometry
MeCN acetonitrile
MeOH methanol
min minute
μwave microwave
N.B. note bene (attention)
PhH benzene
PhMe toluene
POM pivaloyloxymethyl
PPA polyphosphoric acid
PS—BH3CN (polystyrylmethyl)trimethylammonium cyanoborohydride
PTFE (poly)tetrafluoroethylene polymer

Ra—Ni Raney Nickel

Rochelle's salt potassium sodium tartrate
RP-HPLC reverse phase high pressure liquid chromatography
rt room temperature
sat'd saturated
SEM 2-(trimethylsilyl)ethoxymethyl
S-Phos 2-(2′,6′-dimethoxybiphenyl)di-cyclohexylphosphine
t-Bu tert-butyl
tR retention time on the LC/MS instrument
Tf2O trifluoromethanesulfonic anhydride
TFA trifluoroacetic acid
THF tetrahydrofuran
TLC thin layer chromatography
TsOH p-toluenesulfonic acid

Method of Testing Compounds of the Invention Materials

LEADSeeker WGA™ beads and GTPgS35 were purchased from Amersham Bioscience (Piscataway, N.J.). GDP, Saponin™ DAMGO™, Met-Enkephalin, Dynorphin A, NaCl and HEPES™ were purchased from SIGMA (St Louis, Mo.). MgCl2 was purchased from J. T. Baker (Pillipsburg, N.J.). Opioid membranes, hOPRD, hOPRK and hOPRM were prepared at GlaxoSmithkline (Harlow, UK). Cells expressing opioid receptors were prepared as membranes using standard methodologies. Collected cell pellets were homogenized with a blender followed by a low speed centrifugation to remove nuclei and unbroken cells. This was followed by two high speed spins and washes homogenized with a dounce homogenizer. Membranes were stored at −70 C and are stable for at least six months.

Assay buffer; 20 mM HEPES, 10 mM MgCL2, and 100 mM NaCl dissolved in labgrade water, pH 7.4 with KOH.

[35S]GTPgammaS Binding Assay Measured by LEADseeker SPA (384 Well)

Dilute GTPgS35 1:900 in assay buffer in half of required final assay volume (volume A). Add the corresponding standard agonist, Met-Enkephalin (hOPRD), Dynorphin A (hOPRK) or DAMGO (hOPRM) to give a solution concentration of 8×[EC50], for a final assay concentration of 4×[EC50] to volume A. Resuspend LEADSeeker beads in assay buffer in order to generate a 40 mg/mL stock solution. GDP is dissolved in assay buffer at 1 mM. Add beads (100 microgram/well final) to assay buffer containing saponin (60 microgram/mL) in half of final assay volume (volume B). Mix well by vortexing. Add opioid membranes to each respective volume B, for a final assay concentration of 1.5 microgram/well (hOPRD), 1.0 microgram/well (hOPRK), and 1.5 microgram/well (hOPRM). Continuously mix the bead/membrane solution (volume B) for 30 min prior to adding to the GTPgS35 solution (volume A) in a 1:1 ratio using a stir plate. Just prior to adding bead/membrane solution to the GTPgS35 solution, add GDP to volume B at 20 microMolar (10 microMolar final assay concentration). Add the bead/membrane solution to the GTPgS35 solution in a 1:1 ratio. Add 10 microLiters of the bead/membrane/GTPgS35 mix to the assay plate using a Multidrop (Titertek™). Agitation of the solution is needed to prevent the beads/membrane from settling at the bottom. Plates are sealed, spun at 1000 rpm for 2 mins, tapped on side to agitate and incubated at room temperature for 5 hours. Plates are then imaged using a Viewlux Plus™ Imager (Perkin Elmer).

Acceptable compounds of the invention have an activity of less than 30 micromolar using this test method.

Claims

1. A method of treatment comprising the administering a compound which is N-{[3,5-difluoro-3′-(1H-1,2,4-triazol-3-yl)-4-biphenylyl]methyl}-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine or a salt thereof to a human suffering from drug addiction, substance addiction, or a combination thereof.

2. The method of claim 1 wherein said compound is a citrate, phosphate or mono- or di-hydrochloride salt of N-{[3,5-difluoro-3′-(1H-1,2,4-triazol-3-yl)-4-biphenylyl]methyl}-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine.

3. The method of claim 2 wherein said compound is the citrate salt.

4. The method of claim 2 wherein said compound is the phosphate salt.

5. The method of claim 2 wherein said compound is the mono- or di-hydrochloride salt.

6. A method of treatment comprising the administering a pharmaceutical composition comprising (i) a compound which is N-{[3,5-difluoro-3′-(1H-1,2,4-triazol-3-yl)-4-biphenylyl]methyl}-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine or a salt thereof and (ii) at least one carrier or excipient to a human suffering from drug addiction, substance addiction, or a combination thereof.

7. The method of claim 6 wherein said compound is a citrate, phosphate or mono- or di-hydrochloride salt of N-{[3,5-difluoro-3′-(1H-1,2,4-triazol-3-yl)-4-biphenylyl]methyl}-2,3-dihydro-1H-inden-2-amine.

8. The method of claim 6 wherein said compound is the citrate salt.

9. The method of claim 6 wherein said compound is the phosphate salt.

10. The method of claim 6 wherein said compound is the mono- or di-hydrochloride salt.

Patent History
Publication number: 20140100255
Type: Application
Filed: Dec 12, 2013
Publication Date: Apr 10, 2014
Patent Grant number: 8822518
Applicant: GlaxoSmithKline LLC (Philadelphia, PA)
Inventors: David John Cowan (Research Triangle Park, NC), Andrew Lamont Larkin (Research Triangle Park, NC), Cunyu ZHANG (Research Triangle Park, NC), David Lee Musso (Research Triangle Park, NC), Gary Martin Green (Research Triangle Park, NC), Rodolfo Cadilla (Research Triangle Park, NC), Paul Kenneth Spearing (Research Triangle Park, NC), Michael Joseph Bishop (Research Triangle Park, NC), Jason Daniel Speake (Research Triangle Park, NC)
Application Number: 14/103,893
Classifications
Current U.S. Class: 1,2,4-triazoles (including Hydrogenated) (514/383)
International Classification: C07D 249/08 (20060101);